Contents

Panasonic AV-UHS500P Operating Instructions PDF

1 of 188
1 of 188

Summary of Content for Panasonic AV-UHS500P Operating Instructions PDF

Operating Instructions Live Switcher

Model No. AV-UHS500P Model No. AV-UHS500E

ENGLISH DVQP2118ZAW0220GU0 -FJ

Before operating this product, please read the instructions carefully and save this manual for future use. Please carefully read the Read this first! (pages 3 to 7) of this Manual before use.

2

pp Information on software for this product 1. Included with this product is software licensed under the GNU General Public License (GPL) and GNU Lesser General

Public License (LGPL), and users are hereby informed that they have the right to obtain, change and redistribute the source codes of this software.

To obtain the source codes, go to the following website:

https://pro-av.panasonic.net/

The manufacturer asks users to refrain from directing inquiries concerning the source codes they have obtained and other details to its representatives.

2. Included with this product is software which is licensed under MIT-License. 3. This product includes software which is licensed under FreeType Project (www.freetype.org).

For more information about these, refer to the website below. https://pro-av.panasonic.net/manual/en/index.html Details are given in the original (English language) text.

Trademarks and registered trademarks

pp The terms HDMI and HDMI High-Definition Multimedia Interface, and the HDMI Logo are trademarks or registered trademarks of HDMI Licensing Administrator, Inc. in the United States and other countries. pp SDXC Logo is a trademark of SD-3C, LLC. pp Primatte is the registered trademark of Photron Limited. pp Photron Limited is the holder of the intellectual rights to

Primatte. pp Photron Limited is the holder of the patent for Primatte. pp Other names of companies and products contained

in these Operating Instructions may be trademarks or registered trademarks of their respective owners.

About copyright and licence

Distributing, copying, disassembling, reverse compiling, reverse engineering, and also exporting in violation of export laws of the software provided with this unit are expressly prohibited.

Abbreviations

The following abbreviations are used in this manual.

pp Both SDHC memory cards and SDXC memory cards are described as memory cards in this manual. When individual descriptions are provided, they are featured individually. pp Personal computers are referred to as computers.

Furthermore, the product numbers of equipment are referred to as follows.

Model number of unit Model number given in

manual

AV-UHS500P AV-UHS500

AV-UHS500E AV-UHS500

AV-UHS5M1G AV-UHS5M1

AV-UHS5M2G AV-UHS5M2

AV-UHS5M3G AV-UHS5M3

AV-UHS5M4G AV-UHS5M4

AV-UHS5M5G AV-UHS5M5

Illustrations and screen displays featured in the manual

pp What is shown in the manuals illustrations and screen displays may differ from how it is actually appears.

3

Read this first!

indicates safety information.

WARNING: Always keep memory cards (optional accessory) or accessory (mounting screws) out of the reach of babies and small children.

WARNING: This equipment is compliant with Class A of CISPR 32. In a residential environment this equipment may cause radio interference.

CAUTION: A coin type battery is installed inside of the unit. Do not expose the unit to excessive heat such as sunshine, fire or the like.

CAUTION: To reduce the risk of fire or electric shock, refer mounting of the optional interface boards to qualified service personnel.

WARNING: To reduce the risk of fire or electric shock, do not

expose this equipment to rain or moisture. To reduce the risk of fire or electric shock, keep

this equipment away from all liquids. Use and store only in locations which are not exposed to the risk of dripping or splashing liquids, and do not place any liquid containers on top of the equipment.

CAUTION: To reduce the risk of fire or electric shock and annoying interference, use the recommended accessories only.

CAUTION: In order to maintain adequate ventilation, do not install or place this unit in a bookcase, built-in cabinet or any other confined space. To prevent risk of electric shock or fire hazard due to overheating, ensure that curtains and any other materials do not obstruct the ventilation.

CAUTION: The mains plug of the power supply cord shall remain readily operable. The AC receptacle (mains socket outlet) shall be installed near the equipment and shall be easily accessible. To completely disconnect this equipment from the AC mains, disconnect the power cord plug from the AC receptacle.

WARNING: This equipment must be grounded. To ensure safe operation, the three-pin plug must be inserted only into a standard three-pin power outlet which is effectively grounded through normal household wiring. Extension cords used with the equipment must have three cores and be correctly wired to provide connection to the ground. Wrongly wired extension cords are a major cause of fatalities. The fact that the equipment operates satisfactorily does not imply that the power outlet is grounded or that the installation is completely safe. For your safety, if you are in any doubt about the effective grounding of the power outlet, please consult a qualified electrician.

CAUTION: This apparatus can be operated at a voltage in the range of 100 240 V AC. Voltages other than 120 V are not intended for U.S.A. and Canada. Operation at a voltage other than 120 V AC may require the use of a different AC plug. Please contact either a local or foreign Panasonic authorized service center for assistance in selecting an alternate AC plug.

CAUTION: Do not remove panel covers by unscrewing. To reduce the risk of electric shock, do not remove the covers. No user serviceable parts inside. Refer servicing to qualified service personnel.

CAUTION: Naked flame sources, such as lighted candles, should not be placed on the apparatus.

For U.S.A. and Canada

4

The symbols on this product (including the accessories) represent the following:

AC

Read this first!

FCC NOTICE (USA)

Suppliers Declaration of Conformity Model Number: AV-UHS500P Trade Name: Panasonic Responsible Party: Panasonic Corporation of North America Two Riverfront Plaza, Newark, NJ 07102 Support contact: 1-800-524-1448

This device complies with part 15 of the FCC Rules. Operation is subject to the following two conditions: (1) This device may not cause harmful interference, and (2) this device must accept any interference received, including interference that may cause undesired operation.

FCC Note: This equipment has been tested and found to comply with the limits for a class A digital device, pursuant to Part 15 of the FCC Rules. These limits are designed to provide reasonable protection against harmful interference when the equipment is operated in a commercial environment. This equipment generates, uses, and can radiate radio frequency energy, and if not installed and used in accordance with the instruction manual, may cause harmful interference to radio communications. Operation of this equipment in a residential area is likely to cause harmful interference in which case the user will be required to correct the interference at his own expense.

Warning: To assure continued FCC emission limit compliance, the user must use only shielded interface cables when connecting to external units. Also, any unauthorized changes or modifications to this equipment could void the users authority to operate it.

NOTIFICATION (Canada)

CAN ICES-3 (A)/NMB-3(A)

For AV-UHS500P

5

Read this first!

For AV-UHS500E

Caution for AC Mains Lead FOR YOUR SAFETY PLEASE READ THE FOLLOWING TEXT CAREFULLY. This product is equipped with 3 types of AC mains cable.

Appropriate mains cable must be used in each local area, since the other type of mains cable is not suitable.

FOR CONTINENTAL EUROPE, ETC. Not to be used in the U.K.

FOR U.K. ONLY If the plug supplied is not suitable for your socket outlet, it should be cut off and appropriate one fitted.

FOR INDIA ONLY

FOR U.K. ONLY

This appliance is supplied with a moulded three pin mains plug for your safety and convenience. A 13 amp fuse is fitted in this plug. Should the fuse need to be replaced please ensure that the replacement fuse has a rating of 13 amps and that it is approved by ASTA or BSI to BS1362. Check for the ASTA mark or the BSI mark on the body of the fuse.

If the plug contains a removable fuse cover you must ensure that it is refitted when the fuse is replaced. If you lose the fuse cover the plug must not be used until a replacement cover is obtained. A replacement fuse cover can be purchased from your local Panasonic Dealer.

How to replace the fuse 1. Open the fuse compartment with a screwdriver.

2. Replace the fuse.

Fuse

indicates safety information.

Manufactured by: Panasonic Corporation, Osaka, Japan Importers name and address of pursuant to EU rules: Panasonic Marketing Europe GmbH Panasonic Testing Centre Winsbergring 15, 22525 Hamburg, Germany

6

Read this first!

EMC NOTICE FOR THE PURCHASER/USER OF THE APPARATUS

1. Pre-requisite conditions to achieving compliance with the above standards

<1> Peripheral equipment to be connected to the apparatus and special connecting cables The purchaser/user is urged to use only equipment which has been recommended by us as peripheral equipment to

be connected to the apparatus. The purchaser/user is urged to use only the connecting cables described below.

<2> For the connecting cables, use shielded cables which suit the intended purpose of the apparatus. Video signal connecting cables

Use double shielded coaxial cables, which are designed for 75-ohm type high-frequency applications, for SDI (Serial Digital Interface). Coaxial cables, which are designed for 75-ohm type high-frequency applications, are recommended for analog video signals.

Audio signal connecting cables If your apparatus supports AES/EBU serial digital audio signals, use cables designed for AES/EBU. Use shielded cables, which provide quality performance for high-frequency transmission applications, for analog audio signals.

Other connecting cables (LAN, RS-422) Use shielded cables, which provide quality performance for high-frequency applications, as connecting cables.

When connecting to the DVI signal terminal, use a cable with a ferrite core. If your apparatus is supplied with ferrite core(s), they must be attached on cable(s) following instructions in this

manual.

2. Performance level The performance level of the apparatus is equivalent to or better than the performance level required by these standards.

However, the apparatus may be adversely affected by interference if it is being used in an EMC environment, such as an area where strong electromagnetic fields are generated (by the presence of signal transmission towers, cellular phones, etc.). In order to minimize the adverse effects of the interference on the apparatus in cases like this, it is recommended that the following steps be taken with the apparatus being affected and with its operating environment:

1. Place the apparatus at a distance from the source of the interference. 2. Change the direction of the apparatus. 3. Change the connection method used for the apparatus. 4. Connect the apparatus to another power outlet where the power is not shared by any other appliances.

EU

Disposal of Old Equipment and Batteries Only for European Union and countries with recycling systems These symbols on the products, packaging, and/or accompanying documents mean that used electrical and electronic products and batteries must not be mixed with general household waste. For proper treatment, recovery and recycling of old products and used batteries, please take them to applicable collection points in accordance with your national legislation. By disposing of them correctly, you will help to save valuable resources and prevent any potential negative effects on human health and the environment. For more information about collection and recycling, please contact your local authority, dealer or supplier. Penalties may be applicable for incorrect disposal of this waste, in accordance with national legislation

Note for the battery symbol (bottom symbol): This symbol might be used in combination with a chemical symbol. In this case it complies with the requirement set by the Directive for the chemical involved.

Turkey Only AEEE Ynetmeliine Uygundur. AEEE Complies with Directive of Turkey.

TO REMOVE BATTERY Back-up Battery (Lithium Battery) For the removal of the battery for disposal at the end of its service life, please consult your dealer.

7

: Panasonic Corporation : Kadoma, Osaka, Japan , , : Japan

: : , 7, , 03022,

:

7

, .

: X X XXXXXXX

: (6 2016, 7 2017,0 2020) : , L

Read this first!

8

Contents

Read this first! ............................................. 3

Before use .................................................. 11 Overview ......................................................................... 11

Concerning the ratings display .................................... 11

Disclaimer of warranty .................................................. 11

Network security ............................................................ 11

Precautions for use ................................... 12

Installation precautions ............................ 13

Features ...................................................... 14

Accessories ............................................... 15

Installation and connections .................... 15 How to install the optional units ................................... 15

Parts and their functions .......................... 17

Control panel ................................................................... 17

Crosspoint area .............................................................. 18

Memory/wipe pattern/number key area .......................... 19

User button area ............................................................. 20

Transition area ................................................................ 20

Display area ................................................................... 22

Positioner area ............................................................... 24

Memory card area .......................................................... 25

Rear panel area ............................................................... 26

Preparations ............................................... 27

Turning the units power on and off .............................. 27

Basic menu operations ................................................... 28

Menu configuration and operations ................................ 28

Keyboard screen operations ........................................... 30

Menu delegation function ............................................... 30

Setting the system format ............................................... 31

Setting the date and time ............................................... 31

Basic operations ........................................ 32

Background transition .................................................... 32

Selecting the bus ............................................................ 32

Selecting the bus using the SHIFT function ................... 32

Selecting the bus mode .................................................. 33

Selecting the transition mode ......................................... 33

Manual transition ............................................................ 34

Auto transition ................................................................ 34

Cut transition .................................................................. 34

Wipe .................................................................................. 35

Selecting the wipe pattern .............................................. 35

Selecting the wipe direction............................................ 36

Wipe decorations (border, soft effect) ............................ 36

Setting the wipe start position ........................................ 37

Modifying wipe................................................................ 37

Setting the latency .......................................................... 38

Key .................................................................................... 39

Selecting the key type .................................................... 39

Selecting the key material .............................................. 40

Key transitions ................................................................ 42

Key preview .................................................................... 44

Adjusting the luminance key and linear key ................... 45

Adjusting the chroma key ............................................... 45

Key decorations .............................................................. 49

Masking the key signals ................................................. 50

Flying key ....................................................................... 51

Setting the priority .......................................................... 51

PinP (picture in picture) .................................................. 52

Selecting the PinP channel and material ....................... 52

Selecting Shape ............................................................. 52

PinP adjustments ........................................................... 53

Linking Key PinP and DSK PinP .................................... 53

PinP decorations ............................................................ 54

Trimming settings ........................................................... 55

DSK (downstream key) ................................................... 56

Selecting the DSK type .................................................. 56

Selecting the DSK material ............................................ 57

DSK transitions ............................................................... 58

DSK preview ................................................................... 59

DSK adjustments............................................................ 59

Masking the DSK signals ............................................... 60

Key Link ........................................................................... 61

FTB (Fade to Black)......................................................... 61

Internal color signals ...................................................... 62

Setting the color background .......................................... 62

Setting the Wash effect................................................... 63

Switching the AUX output .............................................. 64

Selecting the AUX output materials ................................ 64

AUX1/2 transitions .......................................................... 64

Setting enable/disable for the AUX1/2 transition ............ 65

Memory ............................................................................ 66

Memory registration ....................................................... 67

Memory recall items ....................................................... 67

Storing the settings in the memory (Store) ..................... 68

Recalling the operations stored in the memory (Recall) ...................................................................... 69

Memory preview ............................................................. 70

Deleting the operations stored in the memory (Delete) ...................................................................... 70

Selecting the buses whose settings are to be registered and or played back ..................................................... 71

Setting effect dissolve (shot memory) ............................ 72

Editing event memory timelines ..................................... 73

9

Contents

Macro memory settings .................................................. 78

Registering memories (Register) ................................... 79

Video memories .............................................................. 80

Recording still images (Still) ........................................... 81

Recording moving images (Clip) .................................... 82

Saving Images in Flash Memory .................................... 83

Playing back moving images (Clip) ................................ 84

Memory card .................................................................... 86

Initializing the memory cards .......................................... 89

Saving data on memory cards ....................................... 89

Loading data from memory cards .................................. 90

Deleting files on memory cards ...................................... 91

Displaying the memory card information ........................ 92

Waveform monitor settings ............................................ 93

Input/output signal settings ..................... 94

Input signal settings ....................................................... 94

Settings for the exclusionary input connectors ............... 96

Settings for the color range for input signals .................. 96

Checking the input signal status ..................................... 97

Setting the frame synchronizer ....................................... 97

Setting the delay amount ................................................ 98

Freezing the input signals .............................................. 98

Setting the material names ............................................ 99

Setting the up-converter ................................................. 99

Color Corrector ............................................................. 100

Setting the HDMI input signals ..................................... 103

Displaying the HDMI input signal information ............... 104

Output signal settings .................................................. 105

Assigning the output signals......................................... 106

Setting the SDI output color range ............................... 106

Setting the HDMI output signals ................................... 107

Setting the down-converter (optional) .......................... 108

Setting the sync signals ............................................... 109

Adjusting the output signal phase .............................. 109

Setting the multi view display ...................................... 113

Setting the screen layout .............................................. 113

Setting the split frame and characters .......................... 114

Setting the tally displays ............................................... 114

Changing the material names ...................................... 115

Setting the level meters ................................................ 115

Setting the input signal marks ...................................... 116

Setting the markers ...................................................... 116

Ancillary settings for the AUX bus, PGM, and PVW ... 117

System settings ....................................... 118

Setting the system format ............................................ 118

Switcher mode settings ................................................ 118

Dynamic range and color range settings ...................... 118

Setting the crosspoints ................................................ 119

Assigning signals to the crosspoints ............................ 119

Setting the crosspoint switching ................................... 120

Button assignments ...................................................... 121

Setting the user buttons ............................................... 121

Setting the date and time ............................................. 122

Network settings ........................................................... 122

Setting the built-in display backlight and button illumination ............................................................... 123

Status displays .............................................................. 124

Alarm status displays ................................................... 124

Alarm message ............................................................ 124

Displaying information about the version and optional units ......................................................................... 125

Initialization ................................................................... 126

Initializing setting data .................................................. 126

Initializing fader ............................................................ 126

Remote camera link functions ............... 127

Settings for connections to remote cameras ............. 128

Selecting the terminals for remote camera connection ............................................................... 128

IP address settings ....................................................... 128

Remote camera port settings ....................................... 129

Remote camera authentication settings ....................... 129

Checking the remote camera connection status .......... 129

Remote camera operation direction settings ................ 130

Remote camera tally control settings ........................... 130

Selecting the cameras to be operated .......................... 131

Controlling in the camera control screen ...................... 132

Remote camera settings .............................................. 133

Selecting the remote camera, checking information, and controlling power ...................................................... 133

Remote camera control speed settings ........................ 134

Remote camera on-screen menu and color bar settings .................................................................... 134

Remote camera lens control settings ........................... 135

Remote camera image adjustment settings ................. 135

Remote camera preset memory playback settings ...... 136

Disabling remote camera control .................................. 136

Controlling in the camera preset memory screen ........ 137

Storing preset memories .............................................. 139

Recalling preset memories ........................................... 139

Deleting preset memories ............................................ 139

Selecting a page of preset memories ........................... 140

External interfaces .................................. 141

Setting the GPI I/O ......................................................... 141

LAN ................................................................................. 144

Controlling with external panels .................................. 145

10

Contents

Preparations ................................................................. 145

External panel settings ................................................. 145

Settings on this unit when external panels are connected ................................................................ 145

List of bus IDs and source IDs ..................................... 146

Appearance .............................................. 149

Specifications .......................................... 150

Setting menu table .................................. 152

Appendix (glossary) ................................ 181

Index ......................................................... 184

11

Before use

pwOverview This unit is a 1 ME digital video switcher which supports a multiple number of 4K, 3G and HD formats. The 12G-SDI-compatible AV-UHS500 4K live switcher has basic functions that rival those in larger high-end switchers, making available to you the same operability you would use for producing HD video when you produce 4K video. With its excellent portability, the all-in-one main unit can easily be transported for use at a variety of live music, sport, and entertainment events. Furthermore, along with compatibility with multiple formats (4K, 3G, and HD), the addition of optional units makes it possible to expand to a maximum of 16 SDI inputs, enabling smooth operation even at events with a large number of cameras. The keyers, which enable a variety of program production techniques, are equipped with a total of five keyers including two channels for chroma keys and two channels of PinP. Furthermore, you are able to flexibly select video output to match your purposes, even when you have scenes using different formats, using features such as the up/down converters, HDR/SDR converters, and the ITU-R BT.2020/ BT.709 converters. We have endeavored to make the product useful in a variety of portable applications, such as special event venues, broadcast vehicles, at university or company presentations, etc., and of course inside broadcasters themselves. This 4K live switcher really exhibits its high performance capabilities when it produces living images on location.

pwConcerning the ratings display The name, model number, and power rating for the unit are displayed on the rear panel.

pwDisclaimer of warranty IN NO EVENT SHALL Panasonic Corporation BE LIABLE TO ANY PARTY OR ANY PERSON, EXCEPT FOR REPLACEMENT OR REASONABLE MAINTENANCE OF THE PRODUCT, FOR THE CASES, INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED TO BELOW:

1 ANY DAMAGE AND LOSS, INCLUDING WITHOUT LIMITATION, DIRECT OR INDIRECT, SPECIAL, CONSEQUENTIAL OR EXEMPLARY, ARISING OUT OF OR RELATING TO THE PRODUCT;

2 PERSONAL INJURY OR ANY DAMAGE CAUSED BY INAPPROPRIATE USE OR NEGLIGENT OPERATION OF THE USER;

3 UNAUTHORIZED DISASSEMBLE, REPAIR OR MODIFICATION OF THE PRODUCT BY THE USER;

4 INCONVENIENCE OR ANY LOSS ARISING WHEN IMAGES ARE NOT DISPLAYED, DUE TO ANY REASON OR CAUSE INCLUDING ANY FAILURE OR PROBLEM OF THE PRODUCT;

5 ANY PROBLEM, CONSEQUENTIAL INCONVENIENCE, OR LOSS OR DAMAGE, ARISING OUT OF THE SYSTEM COMBINED BY THE DEVICES OF THIRD PARTY;

6 ANY INCONVENIENCE, DAMAGES OR LOSSES RESULTING FROM ACCIDENTS CAUSED BY AN INADEQUATE INSTALLATION METHOD OR ANY FACTORS OTHER THAN A DEFECT IN THE PRODUCT ITSELF;

7 LOSS OF REGISTERED DATA CAUSED BY ANY FAILURE;

8 ANY DAMAGE OR CLAIMS DUE TO LOSS OR LEAKAGE OF IMAGE DATA OR SETTING DATA SAVED ON THIS UNIT OR ON A MEMORY CARD OR COMPUTER.

pwNetwork security The unit also has functions which are used when it is connected to a network. Using the unit when it has been connected to a network may possibly give rise to the following issues.

1 Leakage or theft of information through this unit 2 Use of this unit for illegal operations by persons with

malicious intent 3 Interference with or stoppage of this unit by persons

with malicious intent

It is your responsibility to take precautions such as those described below to protect yourself against the above network security risks.

pp Use this unit in a network secured by a firewall, etc. pp If this unit is connected to a network that includes

computers, make sure that the system is not infected by computer viruses or other malicious entities (using a regularly updated antivirus program, anti-spyware program, etc.).

The following points should be borne in mind as well. pp Use with the same segment is recommended for the

equipment which is connected to the unit. If the unit is connected to equipment whose segments are different, events dependent upon the settings inherent to the network equipment, for instance, may occur so thoroughly check the connections with the equipment to which the unit will be connected prior to the start of operation. pp Do not choose an installation location where the unit,

cables and other parts will be easily damaged.

12

Precautions for use

p Handle carefully. Do not drop the product, or subject it to strong shock or

vibration. Do not carry or move the product by the fader lever. This is important to prevent malfunctioning or accidents.

p Use the product in an ambient temperature of 0 C to 40 C (32 F to 104 F).

Avoid using the product at a cold place below 0 C (32 F) or at a hot place above 40 C (104 F) because extremely low or high temperature will adversely affect the parts inside.

p Power off before connecting or disconnecting cables.

Before plugging or unplugging the cables, be sure to switch power off.

p Avoid humidity and dust. Avoid using the product at a humid, dusty place because

much humidity and dust will cause damage to the parts inside.

p Maintenance Turn off the units power and wipe the product using a dry

cloth. To remove stubborn dirt, dip a cloth into a diluted solution of kitchen detergent (neutral), wring it out well, and wipe the product gently. Then, after wiping the product with a moist cloth, wipe it again with a dry cloth.

Avoid using benzine, paint thinners and other volatile fluids.

If a chemical cleaning cloth is to be used, carefully read through the precautions for its use.

Caution

p Precaution to be observed during production

This products image switching and image effect functions can be used to produce images which flicker rapidly or images which change rapidly.

However, bear in mind when using these functions in production that the kinds of images produced may have an adverse effect on the viewers physical well-being.

p Built-in display (LCD monitor) Leaving the built-in display on with the same image over

a long period of time may result in temporary afterimage (burn-in).

Such afterimages are usually resolved when ordinary moving images are displayed for a while.

The liquid crystal parts are highly precise with 99.99% of the pixels effective. This leaves less than 0.01% of pixels that may not light or may remain on all the time.

These phenomena are normal and will have no effect on the images you shoot.

Condensation may form if you use the unit where temperatures fluctuate. Wipe dry with a soft, dry cloth.

When the unit has completely cooled down, the display on the LCD monitor appears slightly darker than usual immediately after the power has been turned on. Once the internal temperature of the unit rises, the display returns to the normal brightness.

p When the product is to be discarded When the product is to be discarded at the end of its

service life, ask a specialized contractor to dispose of it properly in order to protect the environment.

p Concerning the consumable parts Cooling fan: This is a consumable part. As a general rule, replace it every 5 years or so (when

the unit has been operated for 15 hours a day).

The period when the consumable parts need to be replaced will differ depending on the operating conditions. When the time comes to replace one of these parts, be absolutely sure to ask your dealer to do the job.

13

Installation precautions

pq In addition to heeding the points presented in the Read this first!, observe the following precautions as well.

Connecting the power supply pp Be absolutely sure to use only the power

cable supplied with the unit. pp The power cable supplied with the

unit has a 3-pin plug with a grounding terminal. Connect to a 3-pin AC outlet which is equipped with a grounding terminal. pp Be absolutely sure to connect the ground terminal

(SIGNAL GND) at the rear of the unit to the system ground. pp When the unit is not going to be used for a prolonged

period of time, turn off its power, and disconnect the power plug from the AC outlet.

Handle carefully! pp Dropping the unit or subjecting it to strong impact or

vibration may cause trouble and/or malfunctioning.

Do not allow any foreign objects to enter inside the unit! pp Allowing water, metal items, scraps of food or other foreign

objects inside the unit may cause a fire and/or electric shocks.

Choosing the best installation location pp Install the unit on a sufficiently strong, stable and level

surface for use. pp Ensure a space of at least 100 mm (3-15/16 inches)

around the units vents to avoid obstructing ventilation. In particular, ensure sufficient space between ventilation and wiring when using mounted in a panel or table. pp Do not install the unit in a manner in which its cables and

other accessories can be easily damaged. pp Avoid installing the unit where it will be exposed to direct

sunlight or to the hot air that is blown out from other products. pp Installing the unit in a very humid, dusty or vibration-prone

location may give rise to trouble.

Ventilation holes

14

Features

Compact design, abundant inputs and outputs pp Despite its compact size, it comes with eight SDI inputs,

two HDMI inputs, five SDI outputs and two HDMI outputs. pp Along with the background transitions using cuts, mixes,

and wipes, the unit is also equipped with five keyers including two channels for chroma keys and two channels of PinP. pp The two multi view display functions enable a single

monitor to be divided so that it can display a maximum of 16 videos. pp Input/output accommodates 4K, 3G, and HD-SDI as

standards, and each input is equipped with a frame synchronizer (FS). pp There are two option slots that combine input and output

functionality, and the addition of optional input units expands input capabilities to a maximum of 16 inputs, and the addition of optional output units expands output capabilities to a maximum of 13 outputs.

Supports multiple formats pp The following signal formats are supported:

4K formats: 2160 59.94p, 2160 50p, 2160 29.97p (*), 2160 25p (*), 2160 24p (*), 2160 23.98p (*) *: Planned support with a firmware update

2K formats: 108059.94P, 108050P, 108029.97Psf, 108025Psf, 108024Psf, 108023.98Psf, 108059.94i, 108050i

HD formats: 72059.94P, 72050P

pp Supports a multiple number of 4K, 2K and HD formats. pp Compatible with a variety of interfaces, such as 12G-SDI,

3G-SDI, 1.5G-SDI and HDMI. pp There are three option slots (with one of these planned to

be available in the future) in the compact chassis of this all-in-one unit. pp The standard eight SDI inputs can be expanded to a

maximum of 16 inputs; the standard two HDMI inputs can be expanded to a maximum of eight inputs. pp The standard five SDI outputs can be expanded to a

maximum of 13 outputs; the standard two HDMI outputs can be expanded to a maximum of eight outputs. pp Equipped with five keyers to enable an abundance of video

effects. pp Equipped with features such as up/down converters, HDR/

SDR converters, and ITU-R BT.2020/BT.709 converters. pp Equipped with four AUX BUS. The AUX1 and AUX2 both

have MIX transition functions, and additionally DSK1 and 2 can be assigned. pp Fitted with a remote camera controller function that is able

to control a maximum of 18 Panasonic 4K/HD integrated cameras. pp High-quality chroma keys enabled with the Primatte

algorithm. pp Video memory (two different systems, still images and

video (1 system only in 4K mode, however)) can be recorded and played back with key signals attached. pp Equipped with a shot memory and event memory function. pp Compatible with SD memory cards, SDHC memory cards,

and SDXC memory cards (*). pp Built-in 7-inch color display.

*: Planned support with a firmware update

Optional units that make possible a variety of expansion functions to suit any application pp SDI Input Unit AV-UHS5M1

Has four 3G or 12G-SDI inputs supporting frame synchronizers, up-conversion, color correction, SDR/HDR conversion, and ITU-R BT.2020/BT.709 conversion. pp SDI Output Unit AV-UHS5M2

Has four 3G or 12G-SDI outputs supporting down- conversion, HDR/SDR conversion, and ITU-R BT.2020/ BT.709 conversion. pp HDMI Input Unit AV-UHS5M3

Three HDMI2.0 inputs There is a scaler function in each of the channels. pp HDMI Output Unit AV-UHS5M4

Three HDMI2.0 outputs There is a scaler function in each of the channels. pp 4K DVE Unit AV-UHS5M5

Equipped with DVE function for the 4K mode. (one BKGD and one keyer)

15

Accessories

Check that the following accessories are present and accounted for.

pp After removing the product from its container, dispose of the power cable cap (if supplied) and packing materials in an appropriate manner.

Power cable for AV-UHS500P ............................................... 1

Power cable for AV-UHS500E ............................................... 3

pp For U.K. and Saudi Arabia pp For Continental Europe, etc. pp For India only

pp This product is equipped with 3 types of AC mains cable.

Appropriate mains cable must be used in each local area, since the other type of mains cable is not suitable.

wSold separately Optional units

Model number Unit Function Supported slots

SLOT A SLOT B

AV-UHS5M1 SDI Input Unit 3G/12G-SDI input 4 lines

AV-UHS5M2 SDI Output Unit 3G/12G-SDI output 4 lines

AV-UHS5M3 HDMI Input Unit HDMI input 3 lines

AV-UHS5M4 HDMI Output Unit HDMI output 3 lines

AV-UHS5M5 4K DVE Unit BKGD output 1 line, Keyer output 1 line,

: Supported

Installation and connections (Be sure to ask your dealer.)

pwHow to install the optional units For details, refer to the operating instructions of the optional unit concerned.

AV-UHS5M1 SLOT A IN-A1, IN-A2, IN-A3, IN-A4

SLOT B IN-B1, IN-B2, IN-B3, IN-B4

AV-UHS5M2 SLOT A OUT-A1, OUT-A2, OUT-A3, OUT-A4

SLOT B OUT-B1, OUT-B2, OUT-B3, OUT-B4

AV-UHS5M3 SLOT A IN-A1, IN-A2, IN-A3

SLOT B IN-B1, IN-B2, IN-B3

AV-UHS5M4 SLOT A OUT-A1, OUT-A2, OUT-A3

SLOT B OUT-B1, OUT-B2, OUT-B3

pp Before installing or removing optional units, turn off the power, and disconnect the power plug. pp Before coming into physical contact with optional units, touch your hand to metal that has been grounded to discharge the

static electricity in your body. A safe way to proceed is to wear an anti-static wrist strap. Optional units may be damaged if you touch them with static still in your body. pp Avoid damage to optional units by not dropping or subjecting to strong shocks or vibrations. pp After removing optional units, be absolutely sure to attach the blank panel. pp When installing or removing optional units, take care not to hurt yourself on the edges or metal parts.

Notes

16

Installation and connections (Be sure to ask your dealer.)

1Turn off the power of the unit, and disconnect the power cable.

2Loosen the four screws of SLOT A or SLOT B at the back of the unit, and remove the blank panel.

Screw

Blank panel

Screw

SLOT A

SLOT B

3Align the optional unit with the guide rails, and insert it slowly. Insert it until it will go no further. Take care not to exert excessive force while doing this since that may damage the connector inside.

4Mount the optional unit in place using the four screws. Clamping torque: 0.7 Nm

Screw

Screw

5After connecting the necessary cables, plug the power cable into the power outlet, and turn on the power.

17

Parts and their functions

Control panel

U1 U2

PICT

STORE

DEL VMEMMACRO

EDIT

U3

MENU MODE

SHOT MEM

KEY1 F/S

PGM A

PST B

KEY2 F/S

KEY3 F/S

DSK1 F/S

DSK2 F/S

MV1 MV2

PGM PVW

FTB ON

KEY1 ON

KEY2 ON

KEY3 ON

DSK1 ON

DSK2 ON

DISP CAM

BKGD PATT

XPT DSBL

TAKE ENTER

7 NEW

8 COPY

9 PASTE

4 INS

5 DEL

6 MOD

1 <

2 >

3 REV

0/10 <<

. >>

C UNDO

CAM PMEM

CAM CONT

EVENT MEM

KEY PATT

-/+ PAGE

RE CALL

MENU OFF

MENU HOLD

WFM VECT

XPT MV

IN OUT

CONF SYS

VMEM MACRO

SHOT EVENT

BKGD CBGD

TIME CAM

PRJ SD Card

KEY1 CKEY

KEY2 KEY3

DSK1 DSK2

U4

USER

MENU

MEMORY / WIPE PATTERN / 10 KEY

AUX BUS DELEGATION AUX /DISP SOURCE

1/13 2/14 3/15 4/16 5/17 6/18 7/19 8/20 9/21 10/22 11/23 12/24

AMBER : FILL / GREEN : SOURCE WIPE DIRECTION

STILL 1 STILL 2 TRIM IN REC

CLIP 1 CLIP 2 TRIM OUT

<

F1 F2 F3

AUX1

AUX

AUX2 AUX3 AUX4 MACRO N/R

BKGD KEY

MIX

CUTSHIFT

SHIFT

SHIFT

AUTO

MIX MIX

WIPE

WIPE WIPE

R

F4 F5

> REV

<< >> TRIM OFF PLAY

STOP

DISPLAY

POWER

ALARM LINK

Z ZOOM

X/Y PAN/TLT

U5 U6 U7 U8

Display area

User button area

Positioner area

Transition areaCrosspoint area

Memory/wipe pattern/ number key area

Memory card area

1 POWER indicator [POWER] This indicator lights when the power switch () on the rear panel is set to ON while power is supplied to the AC power input socket ().

2 ALARM indicator [ALARM] This indicator lights up when any of the following types of trouble has occurred. When the cooling fan has stopped operating When something is wrong with the power supply

(a drop in the voltage) When high temperatures are reached inside the unit

When any of these events has occurred, an alarm message is displayed on the built-in display. When an alarm has occurred, details of the trouble concerned can be checked by selecting the System menu followed by the Alarm sub menu. The alarm information can be output from the TALLY/GPI connector () on the rear panel to an external device.

For further details, refer to Alarm message. When an alarm has occurred, stop using the unit immediately, and be absolutely sure to contact your dealer. Continuing to use the unit even after an alarm has occurred could damage the unit.

3 LINK indicator [LINK] Illuminates when this unit and an external device are linked. Refer to the operating instructions for the external device for settings on the external device.

18

Parts and their functions

Crosspoint area

KEY1 F/S

PGM A

PST B

KEY2 F/S

KEY3 F/S

DSK1 F/S

DSK2 F/S

DISP CAM

AUX BUS DELEGATION

1/13 2/14 3/15 4/16 5/17 6/18 7/19 8/20 9/21 10/22 11/23 12/24

AMBER : FILL / GREEN : SOURCE

AUX1

AUX

AUX2 AUX3 AUX4

SHIFT

SHIFT

SHIFT

MV1 MV2

PGM PVW

AUX /DISP SOURCE

4 PGM/A bus crosspoint buttons [PGM/A 1 to 12]

These are used to select the PGM/A bus video signals. Buttons 1 to 24 can be selected using the [SHIFT] button. Refer to Selecting the bus using the SHIFT function.

A/B, PGM-A/PST-B or PGM-B/PST-A can be selected as the Bus Mode item by selecting the Config menu following by the Operate sub menu. Refer to Selecting the bus mode.

When one of the crosspoint buttons (4, 5, 7) is held down, the name of the input material and the number of the crosspoint button are displayed.

5 PST/B bus crosspoint buttons [PST/B 1 to 12]

These are used to select the PST/B bus video signals. Buttons 1 to 24 can be selected using the [SHIFT] button. Refer to Selecting the bus using the SHIFT function.

A/B, PGM-A/PST-B or PGM-B/PST-A can be selected as the Bus Mode item by selecting the Config menu following by the Operate sub menu. Refer to Selecting the bus mode.

6 AUX bus selector buttons (AUX BUS DELEGATION) Select the bus to be operated using the AUX bus crosspoint buttons (7). The selected button lights.

[KEY1 F/S], [KEY2 F/S], [KEY3 F/S]: This button is used to change the AUX bus crosspoint

buttons (7) into the source selector buttons for the key fill buses or key source buses.

Each time it is pressed, the selector button function is switched between the key fill buses and key source buses.

Amber Key fill buses

Green Key source buses

[DSK1 F/S], [DSK2 F/S]: This button is used to change the AUX bus crosspoint

buttons (7) into the source selector buttons for the DSK fill buses or DSK source buses.

Each time it is pressed, the selector button function is switched between the DSK fill buses and DSK source buses.

Amber DSK fill buses

Green DSK source buses

[AUX1] to [AUX4]: These buttons are used to change the AUX bus

crosspoint buttons (7) into the selector buttons for the sources of the AUX buses.

[DISP/CAM] (built-in display/CAM): When the built-in display is selected, this switches the

AUX crosspoint buttons (7) to DISP bus (the images displayed on the built-in display) source selector buttons.

When CAM is selected this switches the AUX crosspoint buttons (7) to CAM source selector buttons.

The selection switches between built-in display and CAM each time you press the button.

Amber Built-in display selected

Green CAM selected

7 AUX bus crosspoint buttons These buttons are used to select the source of the bus which was selected by the AUX bus selector button (6). Buttons 1 to 24 can be selected using the [SHIFT] button. Refer to Selecting the bus using the SHIFT function.

8 Dedicated crosspoint buttons for the AUX/DISP bus (AUX/DISP SOURCE) While the [AUX1] to [AUX4] AUX bus selector buttons (6) are illuminated, these select AUX bus sources. While the [DISP/CAM] AUX bus selector button (6) is illuminated, it selects DISP bus sources. The buttons that are pressed turn amber.

[MV1/MV2]: Selects either multi view display signal 1 or signal 2 for

the AUX bus or the DISP bus. Switching between multi view display signal 1 and 2 is

done with the [SHIFT] button (7). [PGM/PVW]: Selects either the PGM signal or the PVW signal for the

AUX bus or the DISP bus. Switching between the PGM signal and the PVW signal

is done with the [SHIFT] button (7).

19

Parts and their functions

Memory/wipe pattern/number key area

STORE

DEL VMEMMACRO

EDIT

SHOT MEM

BKGD PATT

XPT DSBL

TAKE ENTER

7 NEW

8 COPY

9 PASTE

4 INS

5 DEL

6 MOD

1 <

2 >

3 REV

0/10 <<

. >>

C UNDO

CAM PMEM

CAM CONT

EVENT MEM

KEY PATT

-/+ PAGE

RE CALL

MEMORY / WIPE PATTERN / 10 KEY

STILL 1 STILL 2 TRIM IN REC

CLIP 1 CLIP 2 TRIM OUT

< > REV

<< >> TRIM OFF PLAY

STOP

9 Number keys When the following buttons are pressed and lit, they serve as buttons for executing their corresponding functions.

BKGD, KEY pattern selector buttons

[BKGD PATT] [KEY PATT]

Memory operation buttons [SHOT MEM] [EVENT MEM] [MACRO] [CAM PMEM]

Video memory operation button [VMEM]

BKGD, KEY pattern selector buttons [BKGD PATT], [KEY PATT]

When the [BKGD PATT] button is pressed and lit, the wipe patterns for the background transitions can be selected using the number keys. When the [KEY PATT] button is pressed and lit, the wipe patterns for the key transitions can be selected using the number keys. When both the [BKGD PATT] and [KEY PATT] buttons are lit, the pattern selection menu is displayed on the built-in display. When the [F1] () is rotated, the pattern page is changed. Refer to Wipe.

Memory operation buttons [SHOT MEM], [EVENT MEM], [MACRO], [CAM PMEM]: These buttons are used to select the memory type. The number keys (1 to 10) are used to carry out

operations and register and call settings. [STORE]: Press this to register data in the memory. [RECALL]: Press this to recall data from the memory. [DEL]: Press this to delete data in the memory. [EDIT]: Press this to edit the event memory/macro memory. Refer to Memory.

Video memory operation button [VMEM] When the [VMEM] button is pressed and lit, video memory operations such as recording and playback can be performed using the number keys. Refer to Video memories.

Camera control button [CAM CONT] Controls connected remote cameras. The positioner () and display mode buttons () are used to control.

20

Parts and their functions

User button area

User buttons (USER BUTTON) [U1 to U8] These are used to assign some functions of the menu settings to the [U1] to [U8] buttons on the Config menu. Refer to Setting the user buttons.

U1 U2 U3 U4

USER

U5 U6 U7 U8

Transition area

FTB ON

KEY1 ON

KEY2 ON

KEY3 ON

DSK1 ON

DSK2 ON

WIPE DIRECTION

MACRO N/R

BKGD KEY

MIX

CUT AUTO

MIX MIX

WIPE

WIPE WIPE

R

[MACRO] button This executes the Macro memory set in XPT with Macro Assign in the menus. The [AUX] button, in which Macro memory is set with Macro Assign in the menus, turns green when the [MACRO] button is selected and turns amber. The registered Macro memory is executed when the illuminated button is selected.

[KEY] button This executes the KEY1 transition when the [CUT] button (), [AUTO] button () or fader lever () has been operated. When the [KEY] button is pressed and it is selected, its indicator lights in amber. If the [BKGD] button () is now pressed, the indicator goes off, and the de-selected status is established. When the [BKGD] button () and [KEY] button are pressed at the same time, both buttons are set to the selected status.

[BKGD] button This executes the background transition when the [CUT] button (), [AUTO] button () or fader lever () has been operated. When the [BKGD] button is pressed and it is selected, its indicator lights in amber. If the [KEY] button () is now pressed, the indicator goes off, and the de-selected status is established. When the [BKGD] button and [KEY] button () are pressed at the same time, both buttons are set to the selected status.

MIX, WIPE selection status LEDs These light up to indicate whether MIX or WIPE has been selected when background transitions or key transitions are executed.

[MIX] button This is used to switch the A and B bus images while making them overlap. During the transition, the A and B bus output total is kept at 100%. When the [MIX] button is pressed and it is selected, its indicator lights in amber. If the [WIPE] button () is now pressed, it goes off, and the de-selected status is established.

21

Parts and their functions

[WIPE] button This is used to execute the transition using the pattern selected by the number key (9). When the [WIPE] button is pressed and it is selected, its indicator lights in amber. If the [MIX] button () is now pressed, it goes off, and the de-selected status is established.

[CUT] button This button is used to execute transitions instantly. Its indicator lights in amber during a transition, and it goes off when the transition is completed. Only KEY1 is enabled when KEY is set.

[AUTO] button This is used to automatically execute transitions (auto transition) using the transition time which has been set on the Time menu. During auto transition its indicator lights in amber. When the button is pressed again during auto transition, the auto transition operation is suspended, and the indicator lights in green. When it is pressed again while auto transition is suspended, the remaining transition is executed. The indicator goes off when auto transition is completed. When the [AUTO] button is pressed while the fader lever () is at an interim setting, the transition is executed in the time remaining from the interim setting. Only KEY1 is enabled when KEY is set.

[FTB ON] button This button is used to execute fade-out to a black screen/ white screen/Still/Clip/color background screen or fade-in from a black screen/white screen/Still/Clip/color background screen for the transition time which has been set on the Time menu.

[KEY1 ON], [KEY2 ON], [KEY3 ON] button This button is used to execute the key transition for the transition time which has been set on the Time menu.

[DSK1 ON], [DSK2 ON] button This button is used to execute fade-in or fade-out of downstream key for the transition time which has been set on the Time menu.

Bus tally LEDs These indicate the output statuses of the A bus and B bus. The LED corresponding to the bus whose program signals (PGM) are being output lights.

Wipe direction selection buttons (WIPE DIRECTION) [N/R], [R]

These buttons are used to select the direction in which to wipe for executing background transitions. When the [R] indicator is off: Wiping proceeds in the normal direction. When the [R] indicator is lit: Wiping proceeds in the reverse direction. When the [N/R] indicator is lit: The normal direction is replaced with the reverse

direction (or vice versa) when the transition is completed.

(The lit and extinguished statuses of the [R] button are also switched in line with the direction of the wiping.)

Fader lever This is used to execute background or KEY1 transitions. When it is moved as far as it will go, the transition is completed. When it has been operated during auto transition, auto transition will be switched to manual operation as soon as the fader position overtakes the amount of the transition being executed.

22

Parts and their functions

Display area

U1 U2

PICT

STORE

DEL VMEMMACRO

EDIT

U3

MENU MODE

SHOT MEM

BKGD PATT

XPT DSBL

TAKE ENTER

7 NEW

8 COPY

9 PASTE

4 INS

5 DEL

6 MOD

1 <

2 >

3 REV

0/10 <<

. >>

C UNDO

CAM PMEM

CAM CONT

EVENT MEM

KEY PATT

-/+ PAGE

RE CALL

MENU OFF

MENU HOLD

WFM VECT

XPT MV

IN OUT

CONF SYS

VMEM MACRO

SHOT EVENT

BKGD CBGD

TIME CAM

PRJ SD Card

KEY1 CKEY

KEY2 KEY3

DSK1 DSK2

U4

USER

MENU

MEMORY / WIPE PATTERN / 10 KEY

STILL 1 STILL 2 TRIM IN REC

CLIP 1 CLIP 2 TRIM OUT

<

F1 F2 F3 F4 F5

> REV

<< >> TRIM OFF PLAY

STOP

DISPLAY

U5 U6 U7 U8

Built-in display The images, waveforms and menus are displayed by operating the display mode buttons (), menu selection buttons () and [CAM CONT] button (). To display images on the built-in display, press the [DISP/ CAM] button of the AUX bus selector buttons (6) so it turns amber. MV, PVW, PGM and AUX bus images can be displayed. To check the camera input, select the [CAM CONT] button (), and while it is displayed in amber, select the [DISP/ CAM] button of the AUX bus selector buttons (6) to display it in green, and select the XPT of the AUX to which the camera you want to check is connected.

Display mode buttons (DISPLAY) These buttons are used to select what is to be displayed on the built-in display.

[MENU MODE]: Each time this button is pressed, the menu mode is

switched.

p Menu-only display

p 1 line of menu display and full-screen image display

p Menu display/Subscreen/Image display

23

Parts and their functions

p Menu display/WFM display (or VECTOR display)/Image display

The image display and the WFM display (or VECTOR display) displayed in the upper portion of the built-in display can be switched by pressing the [PICT] button or the [WFM/VECT] button.

[MENU OFF]: This button clears the menu display and switches to the

image-only display.

[PICT]: When this button is pressed and lit, images are

displayed on the built-in display.

[WFM/VECT]: When this button is pressed and lit, waveforms (WFM:

waveform monitor) or vectors (VECTOR: vectorscope) are displayed on the built-in display.

Each time the button is pressed, the display switches between WFM and VECTOR.

pWFM (waveform monitor) display

p VECTOR (vectorscope) display

Menu selection buttons (MENU) Each time one of these buttons is pressed, the menu of the function indicated at the top or bottom of the button is selected. The button of a selected menu lights up in amber.

[MENU HOLD] button This button is used to keep a menu on the display. When it is pressed while a menu is displayed, the menu displayed will not be switched to another menu even when one of the menu selection buttons is pressed. While the [MENU HOLD] button is pressed, the [MENU HOLD] button lights up in amber.

Rotary encoders [F1] to [F5] These are used to set the parameters which are displayed on the built-in display. Refer to Basic menu operations.

24

Parts and their functions

Positioner area

Z ZOOM

X/Y PAN/TLT

Positioner (POSITIONER) [X/Y] [PAN/TILT] These are used when performing the settings below.

p Key PinP, DSK PinP position settings pWipe start position setting

Target patterns: WIPE1: 5 WIPE2: 4, 5, 6, 7 SQ1: 5 SQ2: 4, 5, 6, 7 Refer to Wipe.

p Flying key position setting p Chroma key marker position setting pWhen entering characters pWhen making settings using the keyboard screen p Pan and tilt control for a remote camera

In each case, the settings take effect only when the following menu items have been selected.

During the time it takes for the unit to start up after its power is turned on, the unit detects the positions of the positioners and sets them to their center positions. Do not touch the positioners until the unit has started up.

Note

Rotary encoder [Z] [ZOOM] This is used to set the PinP size, flying key size or to select the chroma key area. Also used to control the zoom on a remote camera. In each case, the settings take effect only when the following menu items have been selected. It is also used for settings using the keyboard screen.

Positioner Rotary encoder Valid menu

X/Y Z Switch

Key PinP, DSK PinP

Position adjustments Size adjustments (size increased by rotating the encoder clockwise and reduced by rotating it counterclockwise)

Hold switch down to restore initial values (X/Y, Z).

PinP Position

WIPE (BKGD) Start position adjustments

Hold switch down to restore initial values (X/Y).

Background/Position

WIPE (KEY) Start position adjustments

Hold switch down to restore initial values (X/Y).

Key/Position

Chroma key Selection position adjustments

Selected area size adjustments (size increased by rotating the encoder clockwise and reduced by rotating it counterclockwise)

Execute sampling Hold switch down to restore size to initial values.

Chroma Key

Flying key Position adjustments Size adjustments (size increased by rotating the encoder clockwise and reduced by rotating it counterclockwise)

Hold switch down to restore initial values (X/Y, Z).

Key1: Flying Key

When the [CAM CONT] button () turns or blinks amber, these can be used for the PAN/TILT or ZOOM control of the camera that is registered in Camera Information.

25

Parts and their functions

Memory card area

U1

MACRO

MENU MODE

SHOT MEM

CAM PMEM

EVENT MEM

MENU OFF

F1 F2 F3 F4 F5

DISPLAY

Memory card slot Insert an SD memory card (purchased separately), an SDHC memory card (purchased separately) or an SDXC memory card (purchased separately) into this slot.

Memory card access LED This LED lights while the data on the memory card is being accessed. Do not turn off the units power or eject the memory card while the access LED is lit. Doing so can damage the data on the memory card.

pqConcerning memory cards Memory cards used with the unit should conform to SD, SDHC or SDXC standards. Be sure to format cards using the unit. Use SD cards formatted with FAT. (NTFS formatted SD cards cannot be recognized.) Panasonic memory cards with the following capacities can be used with the unit:

SD (from 8 MB to 2 GB) SDHC (from 4 GB to 32 GB) SDXC (*) (from 64 GB to 128 GB)

*: Planned support with a firmware update

For the latest information not available in the Operating Instructions, visit the following Web sites.

https://pro-av.panasonic.net/

pp Memory cards must not be used or stored in an environment where they may be

Exposed to high temperatures/humidities; Exposed to water droplets; or Electrically charged.

26

Parts and their functions

Rear panel area

TALLY/GPI 1

EXPANTION SLOT AEXPANTION SLOT B

REFBOOT SV NM

SIGNAL GND

POWER

LAN12G SDI IN12G SDI OUT HDMI INHDMI IOUT 123451 12 212 345 678

AC IN

ON

OFF

TALLY/GPI 2

Power switch [POWER] When the power switch is turned on, the POWER indicator (1) lights up, and the unit can be operated.

HDMI output connectors [HDMI OUT 1, 2] Connect to external devices with an HDMI cable.

SDI signal output connectors [12G SDI OUT 1 to 5]

Assignable with menus

HDMI input connectors [HDMI IN 1, 2] Connect to external devices with an HDMI cable.

SDI signal input connectors [12G SDI IN 1 to 8] 12G SDI IN 1 to 12G SDI IN 4 can use the up-converter function.

LAN connector [LAN] (RJ-45) (1000Base-TX) Refer to External interfaces.

Ground connector [SIGNAL GND] Connect to the systems earth ground.

AC power input socket [AC IN ] (AC 100 V to 240 V, 50/60 Hz)

Connect one end of the supplied power cable to this socket and the other end to the AC outlet. The supplied power cable comes with a 3-pin power plug. Be absolutely sure to plug it into a 3-point power outlet as the power source in order to earth the unit securely. If a 3-point power outlet is not available for this connection, be absolutely sure to consult your dealer.

Option slot SLOT A [EXPANSION SLOT A]

Option slot SLOT B [EXPANSION SLOT B] Each of these is an input/output option slot. A SDI input unit, HDMI output unit or other optional unit can be installed in these slots. For details, refer to How to install the optional units and the operating instructions of the unit concerned.

TALLY/GPI input/output connectors [TALLY/GPI 1, TALLY/GPI 2] (D-sub 15-pin, female, inch screw) Refer to External interfaces.

BOOT switch [BOOT SV NM] This switch is used for maintenance purposes. For normal operations, select the NM (normal) position.

Reference input connector/BB output connector [REF] Loop-through output in the external sync mode. If the loop-through output is not going to be used, provide a 75-ohm termination. BB signals output from both connectors in the internal sync mode.

Cooling fan

27

Preparations

Turning the units power on and off

pqTurning on the power

1 Set the power switch to the ON position. When power is supplied to the unit, the POWER indicator lights.

1After several seconds, the crosspoint buttons light up.

2Several seconds after the crosspoint buttons have lit up, the opening screen appears on the built-in display. At this point, it becomes possible to select the crosspoints.

3Menu operations can be performed when the opening screen is cleared.

pqTurning off the power

1 Set the power switch to the OFF position. The units power is turned off, and the POWER indicator goes off.

28

Preparations

Basic menu operations

This section describes the basic operations of the menus which are displayed on the built-in display. For the menu configuration, refer to Setting menu table.

Menu configuration and operations

1 Press the [MENU MODE] button to show the menu on the built-in display. Refer to Display area.

2 Select the menu for each function using the menu selection buttons (MENU) that corresponds to the function concerned. Each time the button is pressed, the menu of the function displayed at the top of the button and the menu of the function displayed at the bottom are switched. The button of a selected menu lights up in amber.

U1 U2

PICT

STORE

DEL VMEMMACRO

EDIT

U3

MENU MODE

SHOT MEM

BKGD PATT

XPT DSBL

TAKE ENTER

7 NEW

8 COPY

9 PASTE

4 INS

5 DEL

6 MOD

1 <

2 >

3 REV

0/10 <<

. >>

C UNDO

CAM PMEM

CAM CONT

EVENT MEM

KEY PATT

-/+ PAGE

RE CALL

MENU OFF

MENU HOLD

WFM VECT

XPT MV

IN OUT

CONF SYS

VMEM MACRO

SHOT EVENT

BKGD CBGD

TIME CAM

PRJ SD Card

KEY1 CKEY

KEY2 KEY3

DSK1 DSK2

U4

USER

MENU

MEMORY / WIPE PATTERN / 10 KEY

STILL 1 STILL 2 TRIM IN REC

CLIP 1 CLIP 2 TRIM OUT

<

F1 F2 F3 F4 F5

> REV

<< >> TRIM OFF PLAY

STOP

DISPLAY

U5 U6 U7 U8

21

3

3 Use the rotary encoders [F1] to [F5] to select more detailed settings. [F1] : Turn this rotary encoder to select the sub menu. [F2] to [F5] : Use (press or turn) these rotary encoders to set the parameters.

For further details, refer to the next page.

Operate here using [F1]. Operate here

using [F2].

Operate here using [F3]. Operate here

using [F4].

Operate here using [F5].

Sub menu Parameter setting area

pp The Input and Output menus will differ depending on whether optional units have been installed in the unit.

29

Preparations

List box:

1Press [F2] to [F5] to display the list box.

2Turn [F2] to [F5] clockwise or counterclockwise to select the setting.

p The setting of an item whose selected setting does not blink will be reflected in the unit as soon as it has been selected. p The setting of an item whose selected setting blinks is reflected in the unit by pressing [F2] to [F5].

3Press [F2] to [F5] again to close the list box.

Selector button:

When a rotary encoder [F2] to [F5] is pressed, the setting is switched between On and Off.

Execution buttons:

When a rotary encoder [F2] to [F5] is pressed, the corresponding function is executed.

Numeric value input box:

Turn a rotary encoder [F2] to [F5] to change the numeric value. When a rotary encoder [F2] to [F5] is held down, the numeric value is returned to its initial value. A numeric value bar is displayed and its display is linked to the numeric value.

Inputting numeric values using the number keys

1Press [F2] to [F5] to establish the mode in which numeric values can be input using the number keys.

p Use the . >> button to input the decimal point.

If a numeric value has a decimal point which is not input, it will be treated as an integer, and its decimal places will be set to zero (0).

p Press the -/+ PAGE button to switch the numeric value

between a positive and negative value. Each time this button is pressed, the numeric value is switched from positive to negative (or vice versa).

p If the C UNDO button is pressed when a numeric value

has been input, the numeric value will be returned to the value prior to the change.

2Input the numeric values using the number keys, and press the [TAKE ENTER] button. The values which have been input are entered and reflected in the unit.

pp When a numeric value is input using the number keys and a rotary encoder from [F1] to [F5] is operated, the input value is cleared, and the numeric value prior to input is restored. pp When a numeric value outside the setting range is

input, the value is invalid and the numeric value prior to input is restored.

Character input box:

When a rotary encoder [F2] to [F5] is pressed, the keyboard screen is displayed. Use rotary encoders [F1] to [F5] or positioner to input the characters. Refer to Keyboard screen operations.

30

Preparations

Keyboard screen operations

When a name such as the name of the input signal material, name of the memory or name of the data to be saved on an memory card is to be changed, display the keyboard screen, and input the characters. When the rotary encoder [F2] to [F5] that corresponds to the item (character input box) whose name is to be changed is pressed, the keyboard screen appears on the built-in display.

Character input area

When the keyboard screen is displayed, use positioner or rotary encoders [F1] to [F5] to input the characters (alphanumerics and symbols). The character selected is reflected in the character input area.

[F1]: CURSOR Turn [F1] to move the cursor inside the character input area.

[F2]: SHIFT When [F2] is pressed, the keyboard display is switched (between upper-case letters, lower-case letters and symbols).

[F3]: CLEAR When [F3] is pressed, all of the characters in the input area are cleared.

[F4]: OK When [F4] is pressed, the name which has been input is entered, and reflected in the unit. At this point, the keyboard screen is cleared, and the original screen is restored.

[F5]: CANCEL When [F5] is pressed, the name which has been input is canceled. At this point, the keyboard screen is cleared, and the original screen is restored.

Menu delegation function

When the buttons listed below are double-clicked, the specified menu is selected. (The menu delegation function) The operation corresponding to the button pressed is also executed.

Button Menu selected

Crosspoint area (AUX bus selector buttons)

KEY1 F/S Key menu/Adjust sub menu

When the chroma key is selected: Chroma Key menu/Adjust sub menu When PinP is selected: PinP menu/Position sub menu

KEY2 F/S Key menu/Adjust sub menu

KEY3 F/S Key menu/Adjust sub menu

DSK1 F/S DSK menu/Adjust sub menu

When the chroma key is selected: Chroma Key menu/Adjust sub menu When PinP is selected: PinP menu/Position sub menu

DSK2 F/S DSK menu/Adjust sub menu

Transition area

BKGD Time menu/BKGD sub menu

KEY Time menu/Key1 sub menu

WIPE Background menu/Border sub menu

This setting is used to enable (turn on) or disable (turn off) the menu delegation function.

1Press the CONF SYS button to light its indicator, and display

the Config menu.

2Use [F1] to display the Operate sub menu.

3Use [F4] to set enable or disable for the menu delegation function at the Delegation item.

On Enable

Off Disable

31

Preparations

Setting the system format

One system format (input/output signal) can be selected.

1Press the CONF SYS button to light its indicator, and display

the System menu.

2Use [F1] to display the Format sub menu.

3Use [F3] to select 4K or 2K in the Switcher Mode item, then press [F3] to confirm the selection.

pWhen you switch the Switcher Mode of this unit between 4K and 2K, Initial and a restart are executed. Initial means that all of the current settings are cleared.

4Use [F4] to select the color space in the Color Space item, then press [F4] to confirm the selection.

Setting the date and time

The user can set the date and time to be used as the memory cards time stamp. Be absolutely sure to set them when an memory card is to be used.

Setting the date

1Press the CONF SYS button to light its indicator, and display

the System menu.

2Use [F1] to display the Date sub menu.

3Use [F2] to set the year using the Year item.

4Use [F3] to set the month using the Month item.

5Use [F4] to set the day using the Date item.

6Press the [F5] to enter the year/month/day.

7Press [F1] (YES) to save. Press [F5] (NO) to disable.

Setting the time

1On the System menu, use [F1] to display the Time sub menu.

2Use [F2] to set the hour using the Hour item.

3Use [F3] to set the minutes using the Minute item.

4Use [F4] to set the seconds using the Second item.

5Press the [F5] to enter the hour/minutes/seconds.

6Press [F1] (YES) to save. Press [F5] (NO) to disable.

The time counts up from when the power is turned on.

About the built-in battery for the date/time When the time display is 2014/01/01 00:00:00, the built-in battery for the date/time is exhausted. After recharging the built-in battery for the date/time, set the date and the time.

To recharge the built-in battery for the date/time Turn the power of the unit on and leave it for approximately 3 hours. It can keep the clock settings for approximately 6 months.

32

Basic operations

Background transition

Selecting the bus

Press one of the crosspoint buttons to select the material to be used for the background transition. Depending on the operating status, the button pressed will light in one of two colors.

Lighting in red

When the selected input signals are output to PGM. (However, the indicator lights in amber during FTB operations.)

Lighting in green

When the selected input signals are not output to PGM.

PGM A

PST B

1/13 2/14 3/15 4/16 5/17 6/18 7/19 8/20 9/21 10/22 11/23 12/24

AUX

SHIFT

SHIFT

SHIFT

Lighting in red Lighting in green

pp When the crosspoint buttons are held down, the button numbers and the names of the input materials assigned to the buttons are displayed on the built-in display in the form of a list for as long as the crosspoint buttons remain held down.

Selecting the bus using the SHIFT function

The SHIFT function enables two materials to be allocated the front material and the rear material to one button, and the materials to be selected using the [SHIFT] button. A total of 24 materials front materials (1 to 12) and rear materials (13 to 24) can be allocated to the three groups of 12 crosspoint buttons whether these buttons are the PGM/A bus crosspoint buttons, PST/B bus crosspoint buttons or AUX bus crosspoint buttons.

There are actually two SHIFT functions: All SHIFT for switching all the front materials to the rear materials or vice versa, and Single SHIFT for switching the front material of one crosspoint button with its rear material or vice versa. All SHIFT works once the SHIFT function has been allocated to one of the user buttons. Single SHIFT works once the SHIFT function has been allocated to the No.12 or No.1 crosspoint button of the crosspoint button group concerned by a menu operation.

All SHIFT

All SHIFT is used to switch all the materials of the PGM/A bus crosspoint buttons, PST/B bus crosspoint buttons or AUX bus crosspoint buttons from front materials to rear materials or vice versa. The user button to which the SHIFT function has been allocated is used to switch between the front materials and rear materials.

1Allocate the SHIFT function to one of the user buttons. (For the method used to allocate this function to the user button, refer to Setting the user buttons.)

2Each time the [SHIFT] button (user button) is pressed, the front materials are switched to the rear materials or vice versa.

pWhen the rear materials (13 to 24) have been selected, the [SHIFT] button (user button) lights in amber.

pWhen the button is pressed again, it goes off, and the front materials (1 to 12) are now selected.

33

Basic operations

Single SHIFT

Single SHIFT is used to switch the individual material of a PGM/A bus crosspoint button, PST/B bus crosspoint button or AUX bus crosspoint button from a front material to a rear material or vice versa. Switching between the front material and rear material is done using the crosspoint button in which the SHIFT function is allocated. The SHIFT function can be allocated to button No.12 or No.1.

w Allocating the SHIFT function

1Press the XPT MV button to light its indicator, and display

the XPT menu.

2Use [F1] to display the XPT Setting sub menu.

3Use [F2] to select the button to which the SHIFT function is to be allocated using the Shift item.

Right Button No.12

Left Button No.1

Off Function is not allocated.

4Use [F3] to select the operation to be performed when the [SHIFT] button is pressed using the Shift-Lock item.

Off The rear material is selected only while the [SHIFT] button is pressed.

On The front material and rear material are switched each time the [SHIFT] button is pressed.

p To use the materials that have been set in the button to which the SHIFT function is allocated, either set the SHIFT function Off or allocate the SHIFT function to another button. p If the [SHIFT] button for Single SHIFT is pressed when the rear materials (13 to 24) have been selected using All SHIFT, the bus crosspoint buttons concerned will be switched to the front materials.

pWhen the crosspoint buttons are held down, the button numbers and the names of the input materials assigned to the buttons are displayed on the built-in display in the form of a list for as long as the crosspoint buttons remain held down.

Selecting the bus mode

Select the A/B bus system or flip-flop system (PGM/PST system) from the setting menu.

1Press the CONF SYS button to light its indicator, and display

the Config menu.

2Use [F1] to display the Operate sub menu.

3Use [F2], and select the A/B or PGM/PST (flip-flop system) using the Bus Mode item.

A/B When the fader lever is at side A, the signals selected by the A bus are replaced PGM bus materials. When the fader lever is at side B, the signals selected by the B bus are replaced PGM bus materials.

PGM-A/ PST-B

Using a flip-flop system, the signals selected by the A bus are always replaced PGM bus materials, and the signals selected by the B bus are always replaced PST bus materials.

PGM-B/ PST-A

Using a flip-flop system, the signals selected by the B bus are always replaced PGM bus materials, and the signals selected by the A bus are always replaced PST bus materials.

Selecting the transition mode

Select the transition mode using the [MIX] and [WIPE] buttons.

1Press the [BKGD] button in the transition area so that its indicator lights in amber. When the [BKGD] button and [KEY] button are pressed at the same time, both buttons are selected.

2Use the [MIX] and [WIPE] buttons in the transition area to select the background transition mode. The indicator of the selected button lights in amber.

34

Basic operations

Manual transition

Operate the fader lever to execute transitions manually. If the fader lever has been operated during auto transition, auto transition will be switched to manual operation as soon as the fader position overtakes the amount of the transition being executed. The bus tally LEDs on the left of the fader lever indicate the program bus output status.

Top LED only lights PGM/A bus output

Top and bottom LEDs light

During the transition

Bottom LED only lights

PST/B bus output

Auto transition

pp When the [AUTO] button is pressed, the transition is executed automatically using the transition time which has been set. pp The transition is executed in the remaining time when the

[AUTO] button is pressed while the fader lever is being operated. pp The auto transition time is set using the Time menu.

1Press the TIME CAM button to light its indicator, and display

the Time menu.

2Use [F1] to display the BKGD sub menu.

3Use [F2] to set the transition time in frames.

The display unit is set by selecting Config menu Operate sub menu Time Unit item.

Sec The time is displayed as a number of seconds.

Frame The time is displayed as a number of frames.

Any time from 0 to 999f can be set. The time which can be set when seconds are used as the display unit differs depending on the system format.

59.94i: max. 33s09f 59.94p: max. 16s39f

50i: max. 39s24f 50p: max. 19s49f

29.97PsF: max. 33s9f 25PsF: max. 39s24f

24PsF: max. 41s15f 23.98PsF: max. 41s15f

Cut transition

When the [CUT] button is pressed, the transition is executed instantly.

35

Basic operations

Wipe

Selecting the wipe pattern

The wipe patterns are selected using the number keys.

1Press the [BKGD PATT] button (or [KEY PATT] button). The [BKGD PATT] button (or [KEY PATT] button) indicator lights in amber, and the pattern table screen appears on the built-in display.

2Use [F1] to select the page.

3Use one of the number keys to select the pattern.

4Use [F5] to close the table screen.

p The table screen can also be closed by pressing the [BKGD PATT] button or [KEY PATT] button and turning off the buttons indicator.

pw Table of wipe patterns

pp The SQ2: 8 pattern takes effect when the [KEY PATT] button has been pressed. pp When in 4K mode, only WIPE 1 and WIPE 2 are available. The other patterns are available with the optional 4K DVE unit

(AV-UHS5M5).

VMEM

BKGD PATT

XPT DSBL

TAKE ENTER

7 NEW

8 COPY

9 PASTE

4 INS

5 DEL

6 MOD

1 <

2 >

3 REV

0/10 <<

. >>

C UNDO

CAM CONT

KEY PATT

-/+ PAGE

MEMORY / WIPE PATTERN / 10 KEY

STILL 1 STILL 2 TRIM IN REC

CLIP 1 CLIP 2 TRIM OUT

< > REV

<< >> TRIM OFF PLAY

STOP

36

Basic operations

Selecting the wipe direction

Operate the wipe direction selector buttons to select the wipe direction for the background transition. (The key transitions are set by the menu. The direction which is set here will not be reflected.) See Key transitions.

A

N

B

B

A

B

A

B

A

B

R

A

A B

A

N/R

B

A B

When the [R] indicator is off: Wiping proceeds in the normal direction.

When the [R] indicator is lit: Wiping proceeds in the reverse direction.

When the [N/R] indicator is lit: The normal direction is replaced with the reverse

direction (or vice versa) when the transition is completed. (The lit and extinguished statuses of the [R] button are also switched in line with the direction of the wiping.)

Wipe decorations (border, soft effect)

A border effect or soft effect can be added to the wiping of background transitions.

Setting the border and soft effect

1Press the BKGD CBGD button to light its indicator, and display

the Background menu.

2Use [F1] to display the Border sub menu.

3Use [F2] to set On (or Off) for the border using the Border item.

4Use [F3] to set the width of the border using the Width item.

5Use [F4] to set the amount of soft effect using the Soft item. When On has been selected as the Border item setting, the ratio of the soft effect to the border width is indicated as the amount of soft effect. When only the soft effect is to be added to wipe, select Off as the Border item setting.

Setting the border color

1On the Background menu, use [F1] to display the Border Color sub menu.

2Use [F2], [F3] and [F4] to adjust the Hue, Sat and Lum of the border color.

w To call the preset color

Use [F5] to select the preset color using the Load item, and press the [F5].

pWhen [F5] is pressed, what has been set so far is canceled and replaced with the preset color values. p To save the values that were set before calling the preset color, refer to Memory.

37

Basic operations

Setting the wipe start position

Wipe start can be set at any desired position.

Target patterns: WIPE1: 5 WIPE2: 4, 5, 6, 7 SQ1: 5 SQ2: 4, 5, 6, 7

The WIPE pattern is set using the Position sub menu of the Background menu (or Key menu).

1Press the BKGD CBGD button (or KEY1

CKEY button) to light its indicator, and display the Background menu (or Key menu).

2Use [F1] to display the Position sub menu.

3Either operate the positioners or use [F2] and [F3] to set the wipe start position using the X-Pos item and Y-Pos item. This setting is possible only if the target pattern has been selected for the background or key pattern.

4Either operate the fader lever or press the [AUTO] button to check the wipe operation. (When, for instance, 50 has been set for X-Pos and 50 for Y-Pos, the following screen (or key) appears from the bottom left and wipe is performed while the screen (or key) moves to the screen center.)

Inside screen area Outside screen area

5To copy the start position setting, press [F5] (Copy To Key1 or Copy To BKGD). The background setting is copied to the key setting while the key setting is copied to the background setting.

Modifying wipe

Setting the 3D (page turning) effect

A lighting effect can be added to a wipe pattern. Alternatively, the page turning effect parameter can be set. These effects can be set for background transitions and key transitions.

Target patterns: 3D1: 1, 3, 7, 9

1Press the BKGD CBGD button (or KEY1

CKEY button) to light its indicator, and display the Background menu (or Key menu).

2Use [F1] to display the 3D Modify sub menu.

3Use [F2] to select whether the lighting effect is to be added using the Light item.

On The lighting effect is added.

Off The lighting effect is not added.

4Use [F3] to set the size when images have been reduced using the Size item.

5Use [F4] to set the radius of the page turning effect using the Radius item.

6Use [F5] to set the direction of the page turning effect using the Angle item.

38

Basic operations

Setting the trimming

The trimming at the time a background transition is executed can be set.

Target patterns: SQ1, SQ2, SL, 3D1, 3D2

1Press the BKGD CBGD button (or KEY1

CKEY button) to light its indicator, and display the Background menu (or Key menu).

2Use [F1] to display the Modify sub menu.

3Use [F2] to set the trimming operation and transition operation using the Trim item.

Off No trimming

16:9 For trimming the edges around the material. This setting is used when a black border, for instance, can be seen around the material.

4:3 For trimming using the 4:3 aspect ratio and releasing the trimming when the transition is completed.

4:3 Smooth For trimming using the 4:3 aspect ratio and executing the transition to 16:9 images smoothly.

Setting the latency

A delay amount can be set for the background image or key image.

1Press the CONF SYS button to light its indicator, and display

the Config menu.

2Use [F1] to display the Latency sub menu.

3Use [F2] to set the delay amount for the background image using the BKGD item. Alternatively, use [F3] to set the delay amount for the key image using the Key item.

1F Fix The image is delayed by one frame (1F). p There will be no original image remaining

when wipe is completed (when SQ1, SQ2, SL, 3D1 or 3D2 has been selected as the wipe pattern).

Minimum The image is not delayed. p However, the image will be delayed by one

frame (1F) when SQ1, SQ2, SL, 3D1 or 3D2 has been selected as the wipe pattern or when the flying key has been selected.

w BKGD items Delay amount setting

At times other than during transitions

MIX/WIPE SQ/SL/3D

Minimum No delay No delay 1F delay

1F Fix 1F delay 1F delay 1F delay

w Key items Delay amount setting

At times other than during transitions

MIX/WIPE SQ/SL/3D/ Flying key

Minimum No delay No delay 1F delay

1F Fix 1F delay 1F delay 1F delay

39

Basic operations

Key

This operation combines the background image with another image. The key definition can be adjusted, and an edge can be added to the combined image.

Key1, Key2, Key3, DSK1 (downstream key), and DSK2 are available as materials to compose the background images. The default settings for priority (image positioning) are as shown in the figure below.

Key1

Key2

Key3

DSK1

DSK2

Background image

You can change the prioritization for Key1, Key2, and Key3, and the prioritization for DSK1 and DSK2. Refer to Setting the priority.

How key combinations work is shown in the figure below.

UHS500

UHS500

Background

Key source

Key fill

Output image Invert

Selecting the key type

1Press the KEY1 CKEY button to light its indicator, and display

the Key menu.

2Use [F1] to display the Key sub menu.

3Use [F2] to select the Type item.

Lum (luminance key/ self key)

This is for creating the key signals from the luminance component or luminance and chroma component of the key fill signal.

Linear (linear key/ EXT key)

This is for creating the key signals from the luminance component of the key source signal. It is used when the key source signal and key fill signal are different.

Chroma (chroma key/ self key)

This is for creating the key signals using a specific hue of the key fill signal as the reference.

Full (full key/self key)

This is for creating the key signals using the images on the full screen as the key source signals. PinP combinations are possible in conjunction with the flying key. See Flying key.

Since the luminance and chroma keys are operated as self keys, the key fill signals are used as the key source signals. For the full key, the images on the full screen are used as the key source signals. When the luminance key, chroma key or full key has been selected as the key type, the key signals will remain unchanged even when the key source signals are switched.

When using the linear key, use material with a black background and white characters or shape to be combined by the key as the key source signal. Material which is not black and white may not be combined clearly. Material with a white background and black characters, etc. can be reversed using the key invert function for use.

40

Basic operations

4When the luminance key has been selected, the chroma component can be included in the generation of the key signals in view of the self key application. (This does not apply to the linear key.) Use [F3], and select the setting using the Lum Key item.

Chroma On In addition to the luminance component, the chroma component is also taken into account in the generation of the key signals. This is the setting for using a color with a low luminance component for the key signals (such as when defining blue characters).

Chroma Off The key signals are generated from only the luminance component.

5Use [F4] to select the fill type using the Fill item.

Bus The bus signal is used for the key fill signal.

Matte The internal fill matte is used for the key fill signal.

Selecting the key material

Selecting the key fill and key source signals

Press the [KEY] button in the AUX bus selection area, and switch the selection of the key fill signal (indicator lights in amber) and key source signal (indicator lights in green).

With the indicator of the [KEY] button lit in amber, press one of the AUX bus crosspoint buttons 1 to 12 to select the key fill signal. The indicator of the selected AUX bus crosspoint button lights in amber. (It will light in red if the selected signal is being output from the PGM connector.)

KEY1 F/S

KEY2 F/S

KEY3 F/S

DSK1 F/S

DSK2 F/S

MV1 MV2

PGM PVW

DISP CAM

AUX BUS DELEGATION AUX /DISP SOURCEAMBER : FILL / GREEN : SOURCE

AUX1

AUX

AUX2 AUX3 AUX4

SHIFT

Lighting in amber

With the indicator of the [KEY] button lit in green, press one of the AUX bus crosspoint buttons 1 to 12 to select the key source signal. The indicator of the selected AUX bus crosspoint button lights in green. (It will light in red if the selected signal is being output from the PGM connector.) Since the luminance and chroma keys are operated as self keys, the key fill signals are used as the key source signals. When the luminance key or chroma key has been selected as the key type, the key signals will remain unchanged even when the key source signals are switched.

KEY1 F/S

KEY2 F/S

KEY3 F/S

DSK1 F/S

DSK2 F/S

MV1 MV2

PGM PVW

DISP CAM

AUX BUS DELEGATION AUX /DISP SOURCEAMBER : FILL / GREEN : SOURCE

AUX1

AUX

AUX2 AUX3 AUX4

SHIFT

Lighting in green

41

Basic operations

Linking the key fill signal and key source signal selection

1Press the KEY button to be used to display the menu. (KEY1/KEY2/KEY3)

2Use [F1] to display the Key Signal Coupling sub menu and set Independent.

3Press the CONF SYS button to light its indicator, and display

the Config menu.

4Use [F1] to display the Key Signal Coupling1 sub menu and set Fill/Source.

5Use [F1] to display the Key Signal Coupling2 to 8 sub menu.

p If Key Signal Coupling1 is Fill to Source, select what to use as the Source for the Fill. p Alternatively, if it is Source to Fill, select what to use as the Fill for the selected Source.

When the [KEY] button lights in amber, the key fill signal can be selected, and when it lights in green, the key source signal can be selected. Independent

ON If Fill to Source, you can independently set a Source that is linked to Fill and separate from other KEYs. If Source to Fill, you can independently set a Fill that is linked to Source and separate from other KEYs.

OFF Settings accord with Key Signal Coupling2 to 8.

When the key fill signal is selected, the key source signal also switches automatically. Initially, the key source signal and the key fill signal will be the same signal. For example, when SDI1 is selected for the key fill signal, the key source signal also becomes SDI1. After that, when the [KEY] button is pressed and lights in green, SDI2 is selected for the key source signal. At this time, combination data indicating that the key fill signal is SDI1 and the key source signal is SDI2 is recorded on the unit. After the key fill signal and key source signal have been switched to other signals to perform another operation, if the key fill signal is then selected and set to SDI1, the saved combination data causes the key source signal to automatically switch to SDI2. If the key source signal is changed while the key fill signal is set to SDI1, the combination data is updated to reflect the change, and is recorded on the unit.

When the key source signal is selected, the key fill signal switches automatically. (The [KEY] button first lights amber.)

The initial values for the key source signal and the key fill signal are the same.

Setting the fill matte color

1Press the KEY1 CKEY button to light its indicator, and display

the Key menu.

2Use [F1] to display the Fill Matte sub menu.

3Use [F2], [F3] and [F4] to adjust the Hue, Sat and Lum of the fill matte.

w To call the preset color

Use [F5] to select the preset color using the Load item, and press the [F5].

pWhen [F5] is pressed, what has been set so far is canceled and replaced with the preset color values. p To save the values that were set before calling the preset color, refer to Memory.

42

Basic operations

Key transitions

1Select the transition mode. Press the [KEY] button in the transition area to light its indicator. To execute a background transition and key transition at the same time, press the [BKGD] button and [KEY] button together to turn on both indicators.

FTB ON

KEY1 ON

KEY2 ON

KEY3 ON

DSK1 ON

DSK2 ON

MEMORY / WIPE PATTERN / 10 KEY

WIPE DIRECTION

MACRO N/R

BKGD KEY

MIX

CUT AUTO

MIX MIX

WIPE

WIPE WIPE

R

2Select the transition type. Use the [MIX] button or [WIPE] button in the transition area to select the key transition mode. The selected button lights in amber, and the MIX or WIPE status indicator LED depending on the selected mode lights. If WIPE has been selected, press the [KEY PATT] button in the memory/wipe pattern/number key area to light its indicator, and select the wipe pattern.

VMEM

BKGD PATT

XPT DSBL

TAKE ENTER

7 NEW

8 COPY

9 PASTE

4 INS

5 DEL

6 MOD

1 <

2 >

3 REV

0/10 <<

. >>

C UNDO

CAM CONT

KEY PATT

-/+ PAGE

MEMORY / WIPE PATTERN / 10 KEY

STILL 1 STILL 2 TRIM IN REC

CLIP 1 CLIP 2 TRIM OUT

< > REV

<< >> TRIM OFF PLAY

STOP

3Set the time of the transition. On the Time menu, use [F1] to display the Key sub menu. As with a background transition, set the transition time.

43

Basic operations

4Set the wipe direction. On the Key menu, use [F1] to display the Transition sub menu. Use [F1] to set Normal or Reverse using the Keyout Pattern item.

Normal The key out pattern moves in the same direction as the key in pattern.

Reverse The key out pattern moves in the opposite direction from the key in pattern.

Pattern example 1 Pattern example 2 Pattern example 3 p WIPE1: 5 p WIPE2: 1 to 7

Pattern example 4 p SQ1: 5 p SQ2: 1, 2, 4 to 7 p 3D1: 5 p 3D2: 1 to 3

Key in SQ SQ

Key out (Normal)

SQ SQ

Key out (Reverse)

SQ SQ

: This indicates the areas where keys are combined.

p The operations for pattern example 3 are performed for the WIPE1: 5 and WIPE2: 1 to 7 patterns. p The operations for pattern example 4 are performed for the SQ1: 5, SQ2: 1, 2, 4 to 7, 3D1: 5 and 3D2: 1 to 3 patterns. The same operations are performed for normal and reverse.

5Execute the transition. Press the [AUTO] button in the transition area to automatically execute the transition at the transition time that has been set. Alternatively, execute the transition manually by operating the fader lever.

Key auto transition

When the [KEY ON] button in the transition area is pressed, the transition is automatically executed at the transition time that has been set. During key in, the indicator of the [KEY ON] button blinks in red, and it lights in red when the transition is completed. If the [KEY ON] button is pressed with the picture completely keyed in, the Key image transition (key out) is executed. During key out, the indicator of the [KEY ON] button lights in red, and it goes off when the transition is completed. If the [KEY ON] button is pressed during the transition, the transition direction is reversed.

44

Basic operations Key preview

Key preview images can be output to the preview output, and the keys can be adjusted and checked.

1From the Key menus and the DSK menus, use [F1] to display the Key1/Key2/Key3/DSK1/DSK2 menus.

Key1 menu

Key2/Key3/DSK1/DSK2 menu

Linking of Menus

The PVW settings of Key2, Key3, DSK1, and DSK2 are linked as shown below. Key1, which can be set so that it can be operated with AUTO, CUT, and fader when the panel KEY button is ON, can be operated independently because it is different from the other Keys and DSKs.

Off: Setting is changed to forced Off.

---: No change

PVW images: When PVW is OFF:

The PGM status is displayed in the PVW. This is not reflected in the transition status, however.

When PVW is ON: When PVW is set to On, the PGM images are displayed after the PVW. You can set PVW to On for only one of Key2, Key3, DSK1, or DSK2. Key1 is independent, so a maximum of 2 Keyers can be put on the PVW.

When PVW is Auto: PVW can be set to Auto only for Key1. When you press a KEY button in the transition area, the following two statuses are switched:

When the KEY button is lit, the operation is with PVW On.

When the KEY button is off, the operation is with PVW Off.

Background of the PVW: The BKGD image for PVW is modified by the PVW setting and the setting status of the BKGD and KEY buttons in the transition area. Basically there will be PGM images when either Key PVW or DSK PVW is On. However, these will become PST when both the BKGD and KEY buttons in the transition area are On.

When a user button to which the On/Off settings have been allocated is pressed, the setting is switched alternately between On (button indicator lights) and Off (button indicator extinguished), and the Auto setting is not selected. (The relevant user button items are KEY1_PVW/KEY2_PVW/ KEY3_PVW/DSK1_PVW/DSK2_PVW.)

Menu User button When the user button is pressed

On Lights Off: Extinguished

Off Extinguished On: Lights

Auto Extinguished On: Lights

When Auto is selected using a menu operation, the user button indicator is turned off (extinguished).

45

Basic operations

Adjusting the luminance key and linear key

These steps are taken to adjust the luminance key and linear key definition.

1Press the KEY1 CKEY button to light its indicator, and display

the Key menu.

2Use [F1] to display the Adjust sub menu.

3Use [F2], [F3] and [F4] to adjust the key definition.

4Use [F5] to set key invert. When On is selected, the key signals to be generated internally are inverted.

Operation/ Parameter

Description of setting Setting range

F2/ Clip

Reference level for generating key signals

0.0 to 108.0

F3/ Gain

Key amplitude 0.0 to 200.0

F4/ Density

Key density 0.0 to 100.0

F5/ Invert

Key signal inversion On, Off

Adjusting the chroma key

Sampling is executed for the selected key materials to adjust those aspects of the key that are to be compensated.

Step 1

w To execute the sampling automatically

1Press the KEY1 CKEY button to light its indicator, and display

the Chroma Key menu.

2Use [F1] to display the Auto Compute sub menu.

3Press [F2] to execute the sampling automatically. To undo what has been sampled, press [F5].

w To execute the sampling manually

1Press the KEY1 CKEY button to light its indicator, and display

the Chroma Key menu.

2Use [F1] to display the Sample sub menu.

3Use [F2] to select Composite (composite image that combines the background image and key) using the View item.

4Use [F3] to select Select BG using the Mode item.

Select BG A color for the background of the foreground image is specified. Normally, either a blue or green background is specified.

5Use the positioner to move the position of the sample marker. To change the size of the sample marker, turn the rotary encoder [Z].

6If the sample area that has been set is acceptable, press the rotary encoder [Z]. The area that has been set is now sampled.

7To return to the pre-sampling status after sampling has been executed, press [F5].

46

Basic operations

Step 2

The objective of this step is to remove the noise in the background image. The noise is removed by carrying out this step several times.

1On the Chroma Key menu, use [F1] to display the Sample sub menu.

2Use [F2] to select Matte (Matte image) using the View item.

3Use [F3] to select Clean BG using the Mode item.

Clean BG The noise in the background image is removed.

4Using the positioner, move the position of the sample marker to the position of the noise (white dots) in the background image. To change the size of the sample marker, turn the rotary encoder [Z].

5If the sample area that has been set is acceptable, press the rotary encoder [Z]. The noise in the area that has been set is now removed.

6To return to the pre-sampling status after sampling has been executed, press [F5].

After the noise is removed

Before the noise is removed

Step 3

The objective of this step is to remove the noise in the foreground image. The noise is removed by carrying out this step several times.

1Use [F2] to select Matte (Matte image) using the View item.

2Use [F3] to select Clean FG using the Mode item.

Clean FG The noise in the foreground image is removed.

3Using the positioner, move the position of the sample marker to the position of the noise (black dots) in the foreground image. To change the size of the sample marker, turn the rotary encoder [Z].

4If the sample area that has been set is acceptable, press the rotary encoder [Z]. The noise in the area that has been set is now removed.

5To return to the pre-sampling status after sampling has been executed, press [F5].

After the noise is removed

Before the noise is removed

47

Basic operations

Step 4

After steps 1 to 3 have been carried out, noise will still remain in the detail areas such as the subjects hair as shown in the image below. Noise remaining in the detail areas is also removed in step 4. If there are many areas with noise, the noise is removed by carrying out this step several times.

1Use [F2] to select Composite (composite image that combines the background image and key) using the View item.

2Use [F3] to select Sponge using the Mode item.

Sponge The noise remaining in the detailed areas is removed.

3Using the positioner, move the position of the sample marker to the position of the remaining noise. To change the size of the sample marker, turn the rotary encoder [Z].

4If the sample area that has been set is acceptable, press the rotary encoder [Z]. The noise in the area that has been set is now removed, and the colors become more natural.

5To return to the pre-sampling status after sampling has been executed, press [F5].

p Execute sampling in both the light and dark areas as the sample area. p If the noise in the foreground image is not completely removed by carrying out the steps above, proceed with the FineTuning sub menu operation.

Step 5

The objective of this step is to finely adjust the image by adjusting the noise and transparency, for example.

1On the Chroma Key menu, use [F1] to display the Sample sub menu.

2Use [F2] to select the image to be adjusted using the View item.

Composite Composite image that combines the background image and key

Matte Matte image

Proc.FG Process foreground image

FG Foreground image

3Use [F3] to select the adjustment function using the Mode item. For details on the items, refer to [FineTuning].

4Using the positioner, move the position of the sample marker to the position to be sampled. To change the size of the sample marker, turn the rotary encoder [Z].

5If the sample area that has been set is acceptable, press the rotary encoder [Z]. The area that has been set is now sampled.

6To return to the condition of a step earlier after an adjustment has been made, press [F5].

48

Basic operations

[FineTuning] In this mode, detailed images can be adjusted.

1On the Chroma Key menu, use [F1] to display the Sample sub menu.

2Use [F2] to select Composite using the View item.

3Use [F3] to select FineTuning using the Mode item.

4Using the positioner, move the position of the sample marker to the position to be sampled. To change the size of the sample marker, turn the rotary encoder [Z].

5If the sample area that has been set is acceptable, press the rotary encoder [Z].

6On the Chroma Key menu, use [F1] to display the Fine Tuning sub menu.

7Use [F2] to remove or restore the noise using the Spill item. When it is turned clockwise, a large amount of noise is removed from the foreground image, and the image colors increasingly approach the complementary color (opposite color) of the blue screen. When it is turned counterclockwise, the image colors approach the colors of the original foreground image.

8By turning [F3] clockwise, the matte of the colors closely resembling the colors of the foreground image can be adjusted using the Trans item. This is useful when, for instance, areas covered with dark smoke or clouds in a foreground image are to be made semi-transparent.

9By turning [F4] clockwise, the matte information for the colors closely resembling the colors of the background image can be adjusted using the Detail item. This is useful when, for instance, restoring the details of an image (such as an image with a subject who has loose hair or an image with smoke), which have been lost in the foreground image as a result of sampling, to what they were in the original image.

Step 6

Finely adjust the chroma key signals which have been generated.

1On the Chroma Key menu, use [F1] to display the Adjust sub menu.

2Use [F2], and adjust the width of the chroma key signals using the Narrow item. The key signal width can be adjusted horizontally in 0.5 (half-pixel) increments.

3Use [F3], and adjust the horizontal phase of the chroma key signals using the Phase item. The key signal position can be moved horizontally in 0.5 (half-pixel) increments.

49

Basic operations

Key decorations

A border, shadow or other edge can be added to the key.

Setting the key edge

1Press the KEY1 CKEY button to light its indicator, and display

the Key menu.

2Use [F1] to display the Edge1 sub menu.

3Use [F2] to select the edge type.

Off An edge is not added.

Border A border is added around the entire edge.

Drop A diagonal border is added.

Shadow A shadow is added.

Outline An outline (only a border with no fill) is added.

Border Drop

OutlineShadow

4Use [F3] to set the edge width.

5Use [F4] to set the direction (in 45-degree increments) in which Drop and Shadow will be added.

(Top)

(Bottom)

(Right)(Left)

225180 270

135 315

4590 0

6Use [F5] to set the darkness (Density) of the edges.

Selecting the Edge Fill settings

Materials to be inserted as edges can be set.

1On the Key menu, use [F1] to display the Edge2 sub menu.

2Use [F2] to select the edge material using the Edge Fill items.

Color The color set using Edge Color is used.

CBGD1 The color background is used.

CBGD2

Still1 The still image video memory (Still1) is used.

Still2 The still image video memory (Still2) is used.

Clip1 The moving image video memory (Clip1) is used.

Clip2 The moving image video memory (Clip2) is used.

p Still2 and Clip2 cannot be selected in 4K mode.

Setting the edge color

1On the Key menu, use [F1] to display the Edge Color sub menu.

2Use [F2], [F3] and [F4] to adjust the Hue, Sat and Lum of the edge color.

w To call the preset color

Use [F5] to select the preset color using the Load item, and press the [F5].

pWhen [F5] is pressed, what has been set so far is canceled and replaced with the preset color values. p To save the values that were set before calling the preset color, refer to Memory.

50

Basic operations

Masking the key signals

These steps are taken to mask the key signals using the mask signal of the box pattern.

1Press the KEY1 CKEY button to light its indicator, and display

the Key menu.

2Use [F1] to display the Mask sub menu.

3Use [F2], and select the masking method using the Mask item.

Off The key signals are not masked.

Manual The area that is set using the Mask Adjust sub menu is masked.

4:3 The signals are masked to the 4:3 aspect ratio.

4Use [F3] to set whether to invert the mask signal using the Invert item.

On The mask signal is inverted.

Off The mask signal is not inverted.

5Use [F1] to display the Mask Adjust sub menu.

6Use [F2] to [F5] to set the area to be masked.

Operation/ Parameter

Description of setting

Setting range/ Initial value

F2/ Left

Key left position 50.00 to 50.00/ 25.00

F3/ Top

Key top position 50.00 to 50.00/

25.00

F4/ Bottom

Key bottom position 50.00 to 50.00/ 25.00

F5/ Right

Key right position 50.00 to 50.00/

25.00

The Left setting cannot exceed the Right setting (and vice versa) and, similarly, the Top setting cannot exceed the Bottom setting (and vice versa).

(figure shows the default values)

0

50

-50 500-50

TOP (25)

BOTTOM (-25)

(25) RIGHT

(-25) LEFT

Area masked

Area where the key signal is effective

Video signal range

51

Basic operations

Flying key

Using DVE effects, this key enables the key signals that have been input to be moved, expanded or contracted. In order for the flying key to take effect, select SQ2: 8 as the key transition. Refer to Selecting the wipe pattern.

When the key transition is executed, the keys are combined by the key signals set using the flying key menu. (The transition effect is fixed at MIX.) Since the flying key uses DVE effects, the image is delayed by one frame.

1Press the KEY1 CKEY button to light its indicator, and display

the Key menu.

2Use [F1] to display the Flying Key sub menu.

3Use [F2] to set the X coordinate of the key signal using the X-Pos item.

4Use [F3] to set the Y coordinate of the key signal using the Y-Pos item.

5Use [F4] to set the key signal change size (max. 400: 400%) using the Size item.

Key signal When combined using the flying key

ABC ABC

In order to add the edge of the key before the DVE effect, the thickness of the edge is also changed when the size is changed.

PinP combinations using the flying key

When Full is selected using the Type item in Selecting the key type, PinP combinations can be performed using the flying key. (At this point in time, the Clip item and Gain item cannot be set on the Adjust sub menu.)

With the full key, the image on the full screen serves as the key source signal so an edge will not be added unless a further step is taken. To add an edge, mask the key signals so that the key source signals are made smaller than the entire screen. For details on masking, refer to Masking the key signals.

Setting the priority

The relative positions of the images when Key1, Key2 and Key3 images are to be superimposed onto one another can be set.

1Press the KEY1 CKEY button (or KEY2

KEY3 button) to light its indicator, and display the Key menu.

2Use [F1] to display the Key Priority sub menu.

3Use [F2] to [F4] to set the relative positions using the 3rd item, 2nd item and 1st item.

1st This is used to set the image to be placed at the top.

2nd This is used to set the image to be placed in the middle.

3rd This is used to set the image to be placed at the bottom.

3rd: Key1

2nd: Key2

1st: Key3

52

Basic operations

PinP (picture in picture)

Another image can be combined with the background image. This unit supports PinP for 2 channels, DSK and Key.

Selecting the PinP channel and material

In 2K mode or HD mode: Press the [Key2] button among the AUX bus selector buttons.

In 4K mode or when there is no 4K DVE unit: Press the [Key1] button among the AUX bus selector buttons.

When the [Key2] button (or [Key1] button) is lit, the PinP menu is displayed on the built-in display. The state in which the PinP materials are selected is now established for the AUX bus crosspoint buttons.

The selected AUX bus crosspoint button lights in amber. (It will light in red if the selected signal is a PGM output signal.)

KEY1 F/S

KEY2 F/S

KEY3 F/S

DSK1 F/S

DSK2 F/S

MV1 MV2

PGM PVW

DISP CAM

AUX BUS DELEGATION AUX /DISP SOURCEAMBER : FILL / GREEN : SOURCE

AUX1

AUX

AUX2 AUX3 AUX4

SHIFT

Selecting Shape

Square, Circle, Heart, Flower or Star can be selected as the shape used for combining PinP images.

1Press the [Key2] button (2K/HD mode) or [Key1] button (in 4K mode or when there is no 4K DVE unit) to light the button and display the PinP menu.

2Use [F1] to display the PinP sub menu.

3Use [F4] and, using the Shape item, select the shape used for combining images.

4Use [F5] to adjust the transmissivity (darkness) applying when the images are combined using the Density item.

Full Key On/Off

1In the PinP sub menu, use [F3] to enable (On)/disable (Off) Full Key.

On Irrespective of the values set with the Key sub menu, PinP images are composed with Full Key.

Off PinP images are composed according to the values set with the Key sub menu.

53

Basic operations

PinP adjustments

Adjusting the PinP position and size

While the PinP menu is selected, adjust the X and Y coordinates using the positioner in the positioner area, and adjust the size using the rotary encoder [Z]. Alternatively, the settings can be performed on the menus.

1Press the [Key2] button (2K/HD mode) or [Key1] button (in 4K mode or when there is no 4K DVE unit) to light the button and display the PinP menu.

2Use [F1] to display the PinP Position sub menu.

3Either operate the positioner and the rotary encoder [Z] or use [F2], [F3] and [F4] to set the X and Y coordinates and the size using the X-Pos, Y-Pos and Size items.

Linking Key PinP and DSK PinP

The Key PinP and DSK PinP images perform a symmetrical operation for the axis whose coordinates and rotation angle have been set. The image serving as the reference is the PinP image of the menu being operated.

Linking Key PinP and DSK PinP

1Press the [Key2] button (2K/HD mode) or [Key1] button (in 4K mode or when there is no 4K DVE unit) to light the button and display the PinP menu.

2Use [F1] to display the PinP Sync sub menu.

3Use [F2] to select the position that will serve as the reference using the Sync item. The image serving as the reference is the PinP image of the menu being operated.

When X has been selected as the Symmetry setting

The coordinates and rotation angle are made symmetrical to the X axis.

When Y has been selected as the Symmetry setting

The coordinates and rotation angle are made symmetrical to the Y axis.

54

Basic operations

When Center has been selected as the Symmetry setting

The coordinates and rotation angle are made symmetrical to the center.

When Same has been selected as the Symmetry setting

The coordinates are the same.

Copying the settings

The Key PinP settings can be copied to DSK PinP and, similarly, the DSK PinP settings can be copied to Key PinP.

1On the PinP menu, use [F1] to display the PinP Sync sub menu.

2Use [F2] to select Off using the Sync item.

3When [F5] is pressed, the Key PinP (or DSK PinP) settings are copied and set in DSK PinP (or Key PinP).

The following settings are not copied. p PinP Trim sub menu items p PinP sub menu items

Note

PinP decorations

A border or soft effect can be added to PinP.

1Press the [Key2] button (2K/HD mode) or [Key1] button (in 4K mode or when there is no 4K DVE unit) to light the button and display the PinP menu.

2Use [F1] to display the PinP Border sub menu.

3Use [F2] to set On (or Off) for the border using the Border item.

4Use [F3] to set the width of the border using the Width item.

5Use [F4] to set the amount of soft effect using the Soft item. The soft effect is OFF if 0.0 is set. When On has been selected as the Border item setting, the ratio of the soft effect to the border width is indicated as the amount of soft effect. When only the soft effect is to be added to PinP, select Off as the Border item setting.

6Use [F5] to set the change in the border width using the Mode item.

Fix The border width is kept constant.

Variable The border width changes to suit the PinP size.

Setting the border color

1On the PinP menu, use [F1] to display the PinP Border Color sub menu.

2Use [F2], [F3] and [F4] to adjust the Hue, Sat and Lum of the border color.

w To call the preset color

Use [F5] to select the preset color using the Load item, and press the [F5].

pWhen [F5] is pressed, what has been set so far is canceled and replaced with the preset color values. p To save the values that were set before calling the preset color, refer to Memory.

55

Basic operations

Trimming settings

1Press the [Key2] button (2K/HD mode) or [Key1] button (in 4K mode or when there is no 4K DVE unit) to light the button and display the PinP menu.

2Use [F1] to display the Trim sub menu.

3Use [F2] to set the trimming On/Off in the Trim item.

On Trimming is performed.

Off No trimming

4Use [F3] to select the trimming type.

16:9 Automatic trimming so that the aspect ratio is 16:9.

12:9 Automatic trimming so that the aspect ratio is 12:9.

9:9 Automatic trimming so that the aspect ratio is 9:9.

7:9 Automatic trimming so that the aspect ratio is 7:9.

6:9 Automatic trimming so that the aspect ratio is 6:9.

Manual Trimming using the value set on the Trim sub menu.

5Use [F3] to set the Pair On/Off in the Pair item.

On The settings are changed in such a way that the Left and Right trimming amounts and the Top and Bottom trimming amounts are the same. (This makes for a top-bottom and left-right symmetry.)

Off Pair settings not made.

6Use [F1] to display the PinP Trim Adjust sub menu, and use [F2], [F3], [F4] and [F5] to set the trimming values.

Operation/ Parameter

Description of setting

Setting range/ Initial value

F2/ Left

Trimming value at left

50.00 to 50.00/ 50.00

F3/ Top

Trimming value at top

50.00 to 50.00/ 50.00

F4/ Bottom

Trimming value at bottom

50.00 to 50.00/ 50.00

F5/ Right

Trimming value at right

50.00 to 50.00/ 50.00

(figure shows the default values)

0

60

-60 600-60

TOP (50)

BOTTOM (-50)

(-50) LEFT

(50) RIGHT

Area trimmed

Area where PinP is effective

Original size of PinP

56

Basic operations

DSK (downstream key)

Characters or other images can be combined with the background image. There are 2 types of DSK; DSK1 and DSK2.

Selecting the DSK type

1Press the DSK1 DSK2 button to light its indicator, and display

the DSK menu.

2Use [F1] to display the DSK sub menu.

3Use [F2] to select the Type item.

DSK1: There are 4 options; Lum, Linear, Chroma, and Full. DSK2: There are 3 options; Lum, Linear, and Full.

Lum (luminance key/ self key)

This is for creating the key signals from the luminance component of the key fill signal.

Linear (linear key/ EXT key)

This is for creating the key signals from the luminance component of the key source signal. It is used when the key source signal and key fill signal are different.

Since the luminance key is operated as a self key, the key fill signals are used as the key source signals. When the luminance key has been selected as the downstream key type, the key signals will remain unchanged even when the key source signals are switched.

When using the linear key, use material with a black background and white characters or shape to be combined by the key as the key source signal. Material which is not black and white may not be combined clearly. Material with a white background and black characters, etc. can be reversed using the key invert function for use.

4When the luminance key has been selected, the chroma components can be contained in the key signals generated in view of the fact that it is used as a self key. (This is not applied to the linear key.) Use [F3] to select the setting using the Lum Key item.

Chroma On In addition to the luminance components, the chroma components are also factored in when generating the key signals. Use this setting if colors with low luminance components are used for the key signals (when, for instance, blue characters are to be removed).

Chroma Off The key signals are generated only from the luminance components.

5Use [F4] to select the fill type using the Fill item.

Bus The bus signal is used for the key fill signal.

Matte The internal fill matte is used for the key fill signal.

Setting the fill matte color

1On the DSK menu, use [F1] to display the Fill Matte sub menu.

2Use [F2], [F3] and [F4] to adjust the Hue, Sat and Lum of the fill matte.

w To call the preset color

Use [F5] to select the preset color using the Load item, and press the [F5].

pWhen [F5] is pressed, what has been set so far is canceled and replaced with the preset color values. p To save the values that were set before calling the preset color, refer to Memory.

57

Basic operations

Selecting the DSK material

Selecting the DSK fill signal and DSK source signal

Press the [DSK] button in the AUX bus selection area to switch the selection of the DSK fill signal (indicator lights in amber) and DSK source signal (indicator lights in green).

While the indicator of the [DSK] button is lit in amber, press one of the AUX bus crosspoint buttons 1 to 12 to select the DSK fill signal. The indicator of the selected AUX bus crosspoint button lights in amber. (It lights in red if the selected signal is being output from the PGM connector.)

KEY1 F/S

KEY2 F/S

KEY3 F/S

DSK1 F/S

DSK2 F/S

MV1 MV2

PGM PVW

DISP CAM

AUX BUS DELEGATION AUX /DISP SOURCEAMBER : FILL / GREEN : SOURCE

AUX1

AUX

AUX2 AUX3 AUX4

SHIFT

Lighting in amber

While the indicator of the [DSK] button is lit in green, press one of the AUX bus crosspoint buttons 1 to 12 to select the DSK source signal. The indicator of the selected AUX bus crosspoint button lights in green. (It lights in red if the selected signal is being output from the PGM connector.) Since the luminance key is operated as a self key, the key fill signals are used as the key source signals. When the luminance key has been selected as the downstream key type, the key signals will remain unchanged even when the key source signals are switched.

KEY1 F/S

KEY2 F/S

KEY3 F/S

DSK1 F/S

DSK2 F/S

MV1 MV2

PGM PVW

DISP CAM

AUX BUS DELEGATION AUX /DISP SOURCEAMBER : FILL / GREEN : SOURCE

AUX1

AUX

AUX2 AUX3 AUX4

SHIFT

Lighting in green

Linking the DSK fill signal and DSK source signal selection

1Press the CONF SYS button to light it, and display the Config

menu.

2Use [F1] to display the Key Signal Coupling1 sub menu.

3Use [F2] to select the linking method for the DSK fill signal and DSK source signal by using the Fill/Source item. Fill To Source When the DSK fill signal is selected, the DSK

source signal changes automatically.

Source To Fill When the DSK source signal is selected, the DSK fill signal changes automatically.

When the DSK fill signal is selected, the DSK source signal also switches automatically. Initially, the DSK source signal and the DSK fill signal will be the same signal. For example, when SDI1 is selected for the DSK fill signal, the DSK source signal also becomes SDI1. After that, when the [DSK] button is pressed and lights in green, SDI2 is selected for the DSK source signal. At this time, combination data indicating that the DSK fill signal is SDI1 and the DSK source signal is SDI2 is recorded on the unit. After the DSK fill signal and DSK source signal have been switched to other signals to perform another operation, if the DSK fill signal is then selected and set to SDI1, the saved combination data causes the DSK source signal to automatically switch to SDI2. If the DSK source signal is changed while the DSK fill signal is set to SDI1, the combination data is updated to reflect the change, and is recorded on the unit.

When the DSK source signal is selected, the DSK fill signal switches automatically. However, be aware that if the [DSK] button is pressed when it is not lit, the [DSK] button will first light green, and the mode will be that for selecting the DSK source signal.

58

Basic operations

The recorded combination information can be set from combinations of Coupling1 to 8 in the Key Signal Coupling sub menu.

The initial values for the DSK source signal and the DSK fill signal are the same.

Independently set the selection for the DSK fill signal and the DSK source signal

1From the DSK menu, use [F1] to display the DSK Signal Coupling sub menu.

2Use [F2] to set On/Off in the Independent item.

When the [DSK] button lights in amber, the DSK fill signal can be selected, and when it lights in green, the DSK source signal can be selected.

DSK transitions

1Set the transition time. Press the TIME

CAM button to light its indicator, and display the Time menu.

2Use [F1] to display the DSK sub menu. As with background transitions, set the transition time. Refer to Auto transition.

3When the [DSK ON] button in the transition area is pressed, the DSK image is combined (fades in) for the length of the transition time that has been set.

During fade-in, the [DSK ON] button blinks in red, and when the transition (fades in) is completed, it lights in red. When the [DSK ON] button is pressed after fade-in is completed, the DSK image transitions (fades out). During fade-out, the [DSK ON] button lights in red, and when the transition (fades out) is completed, it goes off. If the [DSK ON] button is pressed at any point during a transition, the direction of the transition is reversed.

59

Basic operations

DSK preview

Select whether to output the DSK preview image to the preview output.

1Press the DSK1 DSK2 button to light its indicator, and display

the DSK menu.

2Use [F1] to display the DSK sub menu.

3Use [F5] to set the PVW item.

On An image with the DSK effect added is output to the preview output.

Off An image without the DSK effect added is output to the preview output.

The PVW On and Off settings can be allocated to the user buttons. Refer to Setting the user buttons.

DSK adjustments

The DSK definition can be adjusted.

1Press the DSK1 DSK2 button to light its indicator, and display

the DSK menu.

2Use [F1] to display the Adjust sub menu.

3Use [F2], [F3] and [F4] to adjust the DSK (downstream key) definition.

4Use [F5] to set key invert. If On is set, the key signals generated internally are inverted.

Operation/ Parameter

Description of setting Setting range

F2/ Clip

Reference level for generating key signals

0.0 to 108.0

F3/ Gain

Key amplitude 0.0 to 200.0

F4/ Density

Key density 0.0 to 100.0

F5/ Invert

Key signal inversion On, Off

60

Basic operations

Masking the DSK signals

These steps are taken to mask the DSK signals using the mask signal of the box pattern.

1Press the DSK1 DSK2 button to light its indicator, and display

the DSK menu.

2Use [F1] to display the Mask sub menu.

3Use [F2], and select the masking method using the Mask item.

Off The DSK signals are not masked.

Manual The area that is set using the Mask Adjust sub menu is masked.

4:3 The signals are masked to the 4:3 aspect ratio.

4Use [F3] to set whether to invert the mask signal using the Invert item.

On The mask signal is inverted.

Off The mask signal is not inverted.

5Use [F1] to display the Mask Adjust sub menu.

6Use [F2] to [F5] to set the area to be masked.

Operation/ Parameter

Description of setting

Setting range/ Initial value

F2/ Left

DSK left position 50.00 to 50.00/ 25.00

F3/ Top

DSK top position 50.00 to 50.00/

25.00

F4/ Bottom

DSK bottom position 50.00 to 50.00/ 25.00

F5/ Right

DSK right position 50.00 to 50.00/

25.00

The Left setting cannot exceed the Right setting (and vice versa) and, similarly, the Top setting cannot exceed the Bottom setting (and vice versa).

(figure shows the default values)

0

50

-50 500-50

TOP (25)

BOTTOM (-25)

(25) RIGHT

(-25) LEFT

Area masked

Area where the DSK signal is effective

Video signal range

61

Basic operations

Key Link

Key1, Key2, and Key3 and DSK1 and DSK2 can be linked in Group1 to 4.

This function makes it possible to link the On or Off setting of the [DSK ON] button and [PinP] buttons ([PinP1 ON] and [PinP2 ON]) with the On or Off (button indicator lights or off) of the [KEY ON] button.

FTB ON

KEY1 ON

KEY2 ON

KEY3 ON

DSK1 ON

DSK2 ON

MEMORY / WIPE PATTERN / 10 KEY

WIPE DIRECTION

MACRO N/R

BKGD KEY

MIX

CUT AUTO

MIX MIX

WIPE

WIPE WIPE

R

1Press the Config button to be used to display the menu.

2Use [F1] to display the Key/DSK Link1 or 2 sub menu, then use Color Group1 to 8 to set the button color linked to each of the buttons.

p There is no linking if OFF is selected. p The button color for each of the buttons is set in the Color Group KEY ON and Color Group DSK/FTB ON sub menus.

Example: When KEY1 of Key/DSK Link1 is set to Color Group 1, then whichever of the KEY2 ON/KEY3 ON/DSK1 ON/ DSK2 ON/FTB ON buttons is set to ON (illuminated), the KEY1 ON button will also be set to ON.

FTB (Fade to Black)

The user can fade out from a program image to the black screen/white screen/Still/Clip/color background screen or fade in to a program image from a black screen/white screen/Still/ Clip/color background.

1Set the duration of the transition. Press the TIME

CAM button to light its indicator, and display the Time menu.

2Use [F1] to display the FTB sub menu. As with a background transition, set the transition time. Refer to Auto transition.

FTB ON

KEY1 ON

KEY2 ON

KEY3 ON

DSK1 ON

DSK2 ON

MEMORY / WIPE PATTERN / 10 KEY

WIPE DIRECTION

MACRO N/R

BKGD KEY

MIX

CUT AUTO

MIX MIX

WIPE

WIPE WIPE

R

3The screen fades out to the setting screen at the set transition time when you press the [FTB ON] button in the transition area.

During fade-out, the indicator of the [FTB ON] button blinks in red, and it lights in red when the transition (fade-out) is completed, and the black screen is displayed.* When the [FTB ON] button is pressed with the black screen displayed, fade-in to the program image is initiated. During fade-in, the indicator of the [FTB ON] button lights in red, and it goes off when the transition (fade-in) is completed. If the [FTB ON] button is pressed at any point during a transition, the direction of the transition is reversed.

*: In the FTB status, the crosspoint button which is normally lit in red lights in amber.

62

Basic operations Selecting the image

The image to be used for fading out can be selected.

1Press the CONF SYS button to light its indicator, and display

the Config menu.

2Use [F1] to display the Assign sub menu.

3Use [F2] to select the image to appear when fading out using the FTB Source item.

Still1 The still image video memory (Still1) is used.

Still2 The still image video memory (Still2) is used. pp Selectable only in 2K mode.

Clip1 The moving image video memory (Clip1) is used.

Clip2 The moving image video memory (Clip2) is used. pp Selectable only in 2K mode.

CBGD1 The color background is used.

CBGD2

White White background

Black Black background

Internal color signals

This unit supports two sets of internal color signals.

Setting the color background

The color background to be used by the bus can be set. Two methods are available: under one method the Hue (hue), Sat (color saturation) and Lum (luminance) are set, and under the other the 8 preset colors (white, yellow, cyan, green, magenta, red, blue and black) are called. The Hue, Sat and Lum of the called colors can also be adjusted.

Adjusting the colors

1Press the BKGD CBGD button to light its indicator, and display

the Color Background menu.

2Use [F1] to display the CBGD1 Main sub menu (or CBGD2 Main sub menu).

3Use [F2], [F3] and [F4] to perform the color adjustments (Hue, Sat and Lum).

w To call the preset color

Use [F5] to select the preset color using the Load item, and press the [F5].

pWhen [F5] is pressed, what has been set so far is canceled and replaced with the preset color values. p To save the values that were set before calling the preset color, refer to Memory.

63

Basic operations

Setting the Wash effect

The gradation effect for color backgrounds can be set.

Selecting the Wash effect and setting the colors

1Press the BKGD CBGD button to light its indicator, and display

the Color Background menu.

2Use [F1] to display the CBGD1 Wash sub menu (or CBGD2 Wash sub menu).

3Use [F2] to set the Wash (gradation) effect using the Wash item.

On The gradation effect is added.

Off The gradation effect is not added.

4Use [F3] to set the color of the Wash (gradation) effect using the Color item.

Dual A dual-color gradation effect is added. (This results in a gradation of two colors, namely, the CBGD1 Main color and the CBGD1 Sub color.)

Rainbow The rainbow color gradation effect is added.

5When Dual has been selected, use [F1] to display the CBGD1 Sub sub menu (or CBGD2 Sub sub menu), and set the sub color.

6Use [F2], [F3] and [F4] to adjust the colors (Hue, Sat and Lum).

Adjusting the Wash waveforms

1On the Color Background menu, use [F1] to display the CBGD1 Wave sub menu (or CBGD2 Wave sub menu).

2Use [F2] to select the gradation waveforms using the Pattern item.

Sine Sine waves are selected.

Saw Sawtooth waves are selected.

3Use [F3] to select the gradation cycle using the Cycle item.

4Use [F4] to select the gradation phase using the Phase item.

5Use [F5] to select the gradation angle using the Angle item.

Setting the Wash movements

1On the Color Background menu, use [F1] to display the CBGD1 Move sub menu (or CBGD2 Move sub menu).

2Use [F2] to set the gradation movement using the Move item.

Off No movement is set.

Roll The gradations are scrolled.

Rotation The gradations are rotated.

3Use [F3] to set the movement speed using the Speed item.

64

Basic operations

Switching the AUX output

Selecting the AUX output materials

The output signals of the AUX buses (AUX1 to AUX4) can be selected.

1Press one of the [AUX1] to [AUX4] buttons among the AUX bus selector buttons. The selected button lights in amber.

2Press one of the AUX bus crosspoint buttons. The selected signal is output to the pressed [AUX1] to [AUX4] button.

KEY1 F/S

PGM A

KEY2 F/S

KEY3 F/S

DSK1 F/S

DSK2 F/S

MV1 MV2

PGM PVW

DISP CAM

AUX BUS DELEGATION AUX /DISP SOURCEAMBER : FILL / GREEN : SOURCE

AUX1

AUX

AUX2 AUX3 AUX4

SHIFT

The button with the signals selected by AUX1 lights in amber.

Name of signal Description of signal

IN1, IN2 SDI/HDMI input signal 1, 2

SDI IN3 to SDI IN8 SDI input signal 3 to 8

IN-A1 to 4, IN B1 to 4

Option slot input signal (SDI, HDMI)

PGM Program video signal

PVW Preview video signal

CLN Clean signal

MV1, MV2 Multi view display output signal 1, 2

KeyOut Key output signal

CBGD1, CBGD2 Color background 1, 2

CBAR Color bar

Still1, Still2 Video memory (still image) 1, 2 pp Still2 is selectable only in 2K mode.

Clip1, Clip2 Video memory (moving image) 1, 2 pp Clip2 is selectable only in 2K mode.

pWhen the AUX bus for which MV has been selected is displayed on the sub screen of the multi view display, the images are looped as if two mirrors were facing each other.

AUX1/2 transitions

The MIX transition is executed when the output signal set for AUX1/2 is switched.

1Press the [AUX1] or [AUX2] button of the AUX bus selector buttons. The selected button and its corresponding AUX bus crosspoint button light in amber.

2Press the AUX bus crosspoint button for the output signal to be switched to. The MIX transition is now initiated for the length of the transition time that was set using the Time menu. While the transition is underway, the transition source AUX button lights in green, and the transition destination AUX button blinks in amber. As soon as the transition is completed, the transition source AUX button goes off, and the transition destination AUX button lights in amber. Furthermore, when another signal is selected at a midway point through a transition, the transition processing continues from that midway point.

KEY1 F/S

PGM A

KEY2 F/S

KEY3 F/S

DSK1 F/S

DSK2 F/S

MV1 MV2

PGM PVW

DISP CAM

AUX BUS DELEGATION AUX /DISP SOURCE

1/13 2/14 3/15 4/16 5/17 6/18 7/19 8/20 9/21 10/22 11/23 12/24

AMBER : FILL / GREEN : SOURCE

AUX1

AUX

AUX2 AUX3 AUX4

SHIFT

SHIFT

Blinks in amber (while the transition is underway).

Lights in green.

65

Basic operations

Setting enable/disable for the AUX1/2 transition

The AUX1/2 transition time and transition enable/disable can be set.

1Press the TIME CAM button to light its indicator, and display

the Time menu.

2Use [F1] to display the AUX1 BUS Trans sub menu.

3When the transition time is to be set in frame units, use [F2] for the setting.

4When the transition time is to be set in second units, use [F3] to set the seconds and [F4] to set the frames.

Any time from 0 to 999f can be set. The time which can be set when seconds are used as the display unit differs depending on the system format. 59.94i: max. 33s09f 59.94p: max. 16s39f

50i: max. 39s24f 50p: max. 19s49f

29.97PsF: max. 33s9f 25PsF: max. 39s24f

24PsF: max. 41s15f 23.98PsF: max. 41s15f

5Use [F4] to set enable or disable for the transition using the Transition item.

On Enable

Off Disable

When disable has been set for the transition, the output signals are switched with no transition when the output signals set in AUX1 is switched.

66

Basic operations

Memory

w Shot memories The background transition pattern, PinP size, border width and other video effects can be registered in the memory and recalled. The memory used for this is referred to as a shot memory. By setting effect dissolve, it is possible to ensure a smooth change of the switching from the current images to the images or operations registered in the shot memory.

w Event memories A multiple number of the video effects which can be registered in the shot memory can be registered and continuously played back while the current event and next event are interpolated to achieve the effect of a smooth transition. A group of these events are referred to as an event memory. Up to 64 events can be registered in one event memory. pp When operations such as playing are performed on event memories with a different system format to when the event

memories were recorded, the operations will not be performed correctly.

Event 1 Interpolation Event 2

Event memory

Interpolation Event 3

w Macro memories This is a function that records a series of operations by the unit and then replays them. You can record and replay across an extensive range of functions that are not covered by the shot memory and event memory (such as input and output settings, etc.). The recorded macros can be replayed by pressing the AUX bus crosspoint buttons or special buttons to which macros have been attached.

Up to a hundred shot memories, a hundred event memories and a hundred macro memories can be registered. The related operations are performed using the number keys. Page 1 to page 10 can be specified for the page numbers of the memories. Numbers 1 to 10 can be specified as the respective memory numbers for the specified page numbers.

Selecting the memory numbers

1Press the [SHOT MEM], [EVENT MEM] or [MACRO] button of the memory to be selected.

2Press the -/+ PAGE button.

The -/+ PAGE button indicator lights up, and the mode for specifying the memory page number is established.

The number key of the currently selected page lights in amber. The number keys of the page numbers in which more than one memory is registered light in green. The indicators of the number keys of page numbers in which no memories have been registered remain extinguished.

3Press the number key (1 to 10) of the page number. When the page number is determined, the -/+

PAGE button indicator goes off, and the mode for specifying the memory number is established. If the page number is not going to be changed, press the -/+

PAGE button to turn off its indicator instead of pressing the number key. This establishes the mode for specifying the memory number.

4Press the number key (1 to 10) corresponding to the memory number. (Hold down the number key when specifying a memory number to register or delete the memory.)

67

Basic operations

Memory registration

Applicable bus

Material selection Transition Pattern Menu Shot

memory target

Event memory

target

Macro memory

target

ME p PGM/A bus p PGM/B bus p Key Fill bus p Key Source bus

p Fader amount p Wipe direction

p BKGD patterns (MIX, WIPE)

p KEY patterns (MIX, WIPE)

p Background

p Key

p Chroma Key

DSK p DSK Fill bus p DSK Source bus

p DSK

AUX p AUX bus

CBGD p Color Background

CLIP p Video Memory

MENU Menu operation Each menu

XPT XPT selection operation

p XPT

OTHER p VMEM Fill bus p VMEM Source bus p DISP bus

: Valid : Invalid

Memory recall items

The targets for memory recall can be selected as On (recall target)/Off (not a recall target) in the Target Select 1 and 2 menus.

Target1, 2 Recall target

ME A/B XPT, BKGD, KEY1, KEY2, KEY3

DSK DSK1, DSK2

AUX AUX1, AUX2, AUX3, AUX4

CBGD CBGD1, CBGD2

CLIP CLIP1, CLIP2

pp CLIP is for the event memory only.

68

Basic operations

Storing the settings in the memory (Store)

Images and operations to be registered can be set and then registered in the memories.

STORE

DEL VMEMMACRO

EDIT

SHOT MEM

BKGD PATT

XPT DSBL

TAKE ENTER

7 NEW

8 COPY

9 PASTE

4 INS

5 DEL

6 MOD

1 <

2 >

3 REV

0/10 <<

. >>

C UNDO

CAM PMEM

CAM CONT

EVENT MEM

KEY PATT

-/+ PAGE

RE CALL

MEMORY / WIPE PATTERN / 10 KEY

STILL 1 STILL 2 TRIM IN REC

CLIP 1 CLIP 2 TRIM OUT

< > REV

<< >> TRIM OFF PLAY

STOP

1Using the unit, set the images or operations to be kept in the memory. To register event memory, refer to wCreating a new timeline in Editing event memory timelines.

2Press the [SHOT MEM] or [EVENT MEM] button of the memory in which the images or operations are to be registered. Depending on the operation that was performed last, the [STORE] button, [RECALL] button, [DEL] button or [EDIT] button lights.

3Select the bus (ME, DSK, AUX, CBGD, CLIP, MENU, XPT or OTHER) to be registered in the memory. From the Shot Memory menu (or Event Memory menu), select the Target Select1/2 sub menu, and then select On. From the Macro menu, select the Store Select sub menu, and then select On. Refer to Memory registration and Selecting the

buses whose settings are to be registered and or played back.

4Press the [STORE] button. The [STORE] button turns amber.

5Press the -/+ PAGE button, and press the number key (1 to

10) corresponding to the page number.

6Hold down (for 2 seconds or so) the number key (1 to 10) corresponding to the number of the memory to be registered. When the registration is completed, the number key corresponding to the memory number lights in green.

p The number keys whose indicators are lit in green have memories already registered in them. Delete the memory corresponding to the number key concerned, and register the new memory.

7Repeat the above steps to register other kinds of settings in the memories.

69

Basic operations

Recalling the operations stored in the memory (Recall)

STORE

DEL VMEMMACRO

EDIT

SHOT MEM

BKGD PATT

XPT DSBL

TAKE ENTER

7 NEW

8 COPY

9 PASTE

4 INS

5 DEL

6 MOD

1 <

2 >

3 REV

0/10 <<

. >>

C UNDO

CAM PMEM

CAM CONT

EVENT MEM

KEY PATT

-/+ PAGE

RE CALL

MEMORY / WIPE PATTERN / 10 KEY

STILL 1 STILL 2 TRIM IN REC

CLIP 1 CLIP 2 TRIM OUT

< > REV

<< >> TRIM OFF PLAY

STOP

1Press the [SHOT MEM] or [EVENT MEM] button of the memory whose operations are to be recalled. Depending on the operation that was performed last, the [STORE] button, [RECALL] button, [DEL] button or [EDIT] button lights.

2Select the bus (ME, DSK, AUX, CBGD, CLIP, MENU, XPT or OTHER) to be recalled from the memory. From the Shot Memory menu (or Event Memory menu), select the Target Select sub menu, and then select On. From the Macro menu, select the Store Select sub menu, and then select On. Refer to Selecting the buses whose settings are to

be registered and or played back.

3When selecting materials using the crosspoint buttons on the operation panel instead of using the registered Material selection item materials, press the [XPT DSBL] button to light its indicator in red. Refer to Memory registration.

4Press the [RECALL] button. The [RECALL] button turns amber.

5Press the -/+ PAGE button, and press the number key (1 to

10) corresponding to the page number.

6Press the number key (1 to 10) corresponding to the number for the memory whose operations are to be recalled.

p In the case of a shot memory, the video effects are recalled, and playback starts. During playback, the number key corresponding to the memory number blinks in green. p In the case of an event memory, the events are recalled, and playback starts. During playback, the number key corresponding to the memory number blinks in green. If there is a PAUSE event, playback pauses at that event, and the number key corresponding to the memory number blinks in amber. Each time the number key corresponding to the memory number is pressed, playback or pause is selected alternately, and this selection is repeated.

7When playback of the effects or events in the recalled memory number starts, the C

UNDO button is enabled, and its indicator lights up. If this button is pressed during playback, playback is terminated.

70

Basic operations

Memory preview

Program output (output to the program signals)

8For program output, press the [TAKE/ENTER] button.

p During output, the [TAKE/ENTER] button indicator blinks in green. p In the case of an event memory which contains a PAUSE event, the output pauses at that event, and the [TAKE/ENTER] button indicator blinks in amber. To resume the output, press the [TAKE/ENTER] button. Each time the [TAKE/ENTER] button is pressed, output or pause is selected alternately, and this selection is repeated.

pWhen output is completed, the [TAKE/ENTER] button indicators lights in amber.

9When program output is started, the C UNDO button takes

effect, and its indicator lights up. If the C

UNDO button is pressed during output, playback is terminated.

71

Basic operations

Selecting the buses whose settings are to be registered and or played back

Bus selection when registering/playing back memories

Select the bus used for registering event memories, shot memories and macro memories.

1Press the SHOT EVENT button to display the Event Memory menu (Shot Memory menu or Macro menu).

2Use [F1] to display the Target Select1, 2 sub menu.

3Use [F2] to [F5] to set the items to be saved to On.

Event Memory menu:

Shot Memory menu:

Macro menu:

On The bus settings are registered in the memories.

Off The bus settings are not registered in the memories.

Page: 1 (1 to 10)

Registering the material selection items

Set whether or not to register the Material selection items of the buses. Refer to Memory registration.

72

Basic operations

Setting effect dissolve (shot memory)

Switching from the current image to the image or operation stored in the shot memory can be performed smoothly.

1Press the SHOT EVENT button to display the Shot Memory menu.

2Use [F1] to display the Path sub menu.

3Use [F2] to set the effect used for switching the images using the Effect item.

Cut The images are switched using the cut effect.

Dissolve The images are switched using the dissolve effect.

p The dissolve effect duration is set in the Effect Dissolve sub menu which is selected in the Time menu.

4Use [F3] to select the effect used for switching the colors using the Hue Path item. The following colors are targeted by Hue.

p Colors of the color background p Colors of the borders p Colors of the edges p Colors of the fill matte

Short The colors are changed toward less hue on the vectorscope.

Long The colors are changed toward more hue on the vectorscope.

CW The Hue is changed clockwise on the vectorscope.

CCW The Hue is changed counterclockwise on the vectorscope.

p Pressed number keys blink in green while the operation switching is underway.

pWhen the operation switching has been completed, the pressed number key lights in amber. pWhen the Effect item is changed from Dissolve to Cut while operation is being switched, the dissolve effect is released, and the images are switched to the images of the selected shot memory in an instant. p During the operation switching, the operation of the fader lever is canceled. p There are cases when it is not possible to recall other memory operations during operation switching: Recalling another shot memory while a shot memory is

operating Recalling another event memory while an event memory is operating

p It is possible to recall a shot memory while an event memory is operating or to recall an event memory while a shot memory is operating, but if there is conflict with the buses or materials played back by the event memory and shot memory, playback occurs after switching to the memory recalled last.

73

Basic operations

Editing event memory timelines

Insertion or modification of the events can be edited on the timelines.

w Timeline A timeline is a succession of events in the event memories which have been joined together on the time axis.

w Event points and edit points On a timeline, the position where an event has been registered is called the event point, and the event currently being edited is called the current event memory. When there is an edit point between one event point and another, the event point before the edit point serves as the current event memory. (Event n in the figure below)

Edit point

Event n

Event n+1

Event n+2

w Event duration and total duration The length of time as far as the next event is called the event duration. The total of all the event durations is called the total duration. The present point in time on the timeline is called the current time.

1s00f 1s00f 1s00f

Event duration

The event stops.The event progresses in this direction.

Current time

Total duration

Event 1

Event 2

Event 3

Timeline editing flow

w Modifying registered event memories

1Press the [EVENT MEM] button and light its indicator.

STORE

DEL VMEMMACRO

EDIT

SHOT MEM

BKGD PATT

XPT DSBL

TAKE ENTER

7 NEW

8 COPY

9 PASTE

4 INS

5 DEL

6 MOD

1 <

2 >

3 REV

0/10 <<

. >>

C UNDO

CAM PMEM

CAM CONT

EVENT MEM

KEY PATT

-/+ PAGE

RE CALL

MENU

MEMORY / WIPE PATTERN / 10 KEY

STILL 1 STILL 2 TRIM IN REC

CLIP 1 CLIP 2 TRIM OUT

< > REV

<< >> TRIM OFF PLAY

STOP

DISPLAY

[EVENT MEM] button

2Press the [RECALL] button to light its indicator, and use the -/+

PAGE button and number keys (1 to 10) to select the event memory to be modified. Refer to Recalling the operations stored in the

memory (Recall).

3Press the [EDIT] button to establish the editing mode. (At this point, the timeline of the selected event memory is copied into the work area.) The timeline appears on the built-in display, and events can be inserted or modified.

4Edit the timeline, and check what has been edited. Refer to the operations described later.

5Register the event memory which has been modified. Refer to Storing the settings in the memory (Store).

w Creating a new timeline

When this operation is performed, the timeline currently in the work area is deleted. If it is required, register it in the event memory.

1Press the [EVENT MEM] button and light its indicator.

2Press the [EDIT] button to light its indicator, and press 7

NEW .

3Create the new timeline. Refer to the operations described later.

4Register the event memory which has just been created. Refer to Storing the settings in the memory (Store).

The timeline is edited in the work area. After editing is completed, be absolutely sure to register which has been edited.

74

Basic operations

Setting the playback method

w Setting the playback mode

1Press the [EVENT MEM] button and light its indicator.

STORE

DEL VMEMMACRO

EDIT

SHOT MEM

BKGD PATT

XPT DSBL

TAKE ENTER

7 NEW

8 COPY

9 PASTE

4 INS

5 DEL

6 MOD

1 <

2 >

3 REV

0/10 <<

. >>

C UNDO

CAM PMEM

CAM CONT

EVENT MEM

KEY PATT

-/+ PAGE

RE CALL

MENU

MEMORY / WIPE PATTERN / 10 KEY

STILL 1 STILL 2 TRIM IN REC

CLIP 1 CLIP 2 TRIM OUT

< > REV

<< >> TRIM OFF PLAY

STOP

DISPLAY

[EVENT MEM] button

2Press the [EDIT] button to establish the editing mode.

3Press the SHOT EVENT button to display the Event Memory

menu.

4Use [F1] to display the Play sub menu.

5Use [F2] to set the playback mode using the Loop item.

Once During normal playback, playback stops at the last event, and if the [TAKE ENTER] button is now pressed, the images are played back in the same direction. During reverse playback, playback stops at the first event, and if the [TAKE ENTER] button is now pressed, the images are played back in the same direction.

Loop During normal playback, playback returns instantly from the last event to the first event, and what has been played back is repeated. During reverse playback, playback returns instantly from the first event to the last event, and what has been played back is repeated.

w Setting the display mode

1Press the SHOT EVENT button to display the Event Memory

menu.

2Use [F1] to display the Timeline sub menu.

3Use [F2] to set the timeline display mode using the View item.

Normal The timeline is displayed in a size which is one-half of the width of the built-in display screen.

Wide The timeline is displayed in the full size (as large as the entire width) of the built-in display screen.

75

Basic operations

A green below the timeline indicates an event point.

A || indicates that PAUSE has been set for an event point.

If an edit point is over an event point, for the event point is indicated in amber.

When CLIP (Clip1, Clip2) has been registered in an event, appears above the event point.

Similarly, when GPI-Out (GPI-O1 to GPI-O19) has been registered in an event, appears above the event point.

The timeline axis is indicated in green from the start event to the end event.

During playback, the part from the beginning to the current position is indicated in yellow.

Similarly, during reverse playback, the part from the end to the current position is indicated in yellow.

w Number key operations

VMEM

BKGD PATT

XPT DSBL

TAKE ENTER

7 NEW

8 COPY

9 PASTE

4 INS

5 DEL

6 MOD

1 <

2 >

3 REV

0/10 <<

. >>

C UNDO

CAM CONT

KEY PATT

-/+ PAGE

MEMORY / WIPE PATTERN / 10 KEY

STILL 1 STILL 2 TRIM IN REC

CLIP 1 CLIP 2 TRIM OUT

< > REV

<< >> TRIM OFF PLAY

STOP

7 NEW

STILL 1

Creates a new timeline.

8 COPY

STILL 2

Copies events. An event is not copied if an edit point is not over the event.

9 PASTE

TRIM IN

Pastes the copied events. If the edit point is an event point, the event is inserted after the event point. If the edit point is at any midway position in an event, the event is inserted at the edit point.

4 INS

CLIP 1

Inserts events. If the edit point is an event point, the event is inserted after the event point. If the edit point is at any midway position in an event, the event is inserted at the edit point.

5 DEL

CLIP 2

Deletes events.

6 MOD

TRIM OUT

Modifies events. This key cannot be operated if the edit point is not over the event point.

0/10 << <<

Moves to the start event point.

. >> >>

Moves to the end event point.

2 > >

Moves to the next event point.

1 < <

Moves to the previous event point.

3 REV REV

Reverses the playback direction (event numbers are put in their reverse sequence).

C UNDO

TRIM OFF

Undoes the editing operation of the event. When the button is pressed, the operation performed last is canceled.

TAKE ENTER

PLAY

Plays back events. When this button is operational, its indicator lights in amber. Each time it is pressed, operation is switched between playback and pause. During playback, its indicator blinks in green; during pause, it blinks in amber.

76

Basic operations

Inserting events (Insert)

The current setting status can be inserted as an event after the current event memory. When an event is inserted, the numbers of the events after the current event memory are each moved up by one.

1Use 0/10 << , 1

< , 2 > and .

>> to select the event point (current event memory) which is to be inserted. To insert the event at a midway point of an event, play back the event to the place where the event is to be inserted, and stop the edit point.

2Operate the panel, and create the event.

3Press 4 INS to insert the created event.

To cancel the event insertion, press the C UNDO button.

pWhen the number of events on the timeline has reached 64, no further events can be inserted. pWhen the edit point is over the event point, the newly created event is inserted with the same duration as the current event memory.

p If the edit point is between one event point and another, the current event memory is split at the edit point position, and the newly created event is inserted.

pWhen registering CLIP (Clip1, Clip2) to event memory, place Current time for Clip1 (or Clip2) at the beginning (from the Video Memory2 sub menu, press [F2] (LEAD)). Some clips might not play back.

Modifying events (Modify)

Already registered events can be modified.

1Use 0/10 << , 1

< , 2 > and .

>> to select the event point of the event to be modified.

2Operate the panel, and modify the event.

3Press 6 MOD to set the modified details.

To cancel the event modification, press the C UNDO button.

Copying events (Copy)

Already registered events can be copied.

1Use 0/10 << , 1

< , 2 > and .

>> to select the event point of the event to be copied.

2Press 8 COPY to copy the event.

Pasting events (Paste)

Copied events can be pasted.

1Use 0/10 << , 1

< , 2 > and .

>> to select the event point where the copied event is to be inserted. To insert the copied event between one event point and another, play back the event to the place where the copied event is to be inserted, and stop the playback.

2Press 9 PASTE to paste the copied event.

To cancel the event pasting, press the C UNDO button.

pWhen the number of events on the timeline has reached 64, no further events can be inserted. pWhen the edit point is over an event point, the copied event is inserted with the same duration as the current event memory. p If the edit point is between one event point and another, the current event memory is split at the edit point position, and the copied event is inserted.

Deleting events (Delete)

Already registered events can be deleted.

1Use 0/10 << , 1

< , 2 > and .

>> to select the event point of the event to be deleted.

2Press 5 DEL to delete the event.

To cancel the event deletion, press the C UNDO button.

p Even if the edit point is midway through an event, the current event memory will be deleted.

Undoing what has been edited (Undo)

When the C UNDO button is pressed, the operation performed last

is canceled.

77

Basic operations

Setting events using the menus

w Registering marks

Marks can be registered and events inserted at the event points.

p Pause p Clip playback p GPI-Out output

1Use 0/10 << , 1

< , 2 > and .

>> to select the event where the mark is to be registered or the event inserted.

2Press the SHOT EVENT button to display the Event Memory

menu.

3Use [F1] to display the Mark sub menu.

4Use [F2] (PAUSE item), [F3] (CLIP item) or [F4] (GPI-Out item) to select the item.

PAUSE When On is selected and the mark is registered in the event point, playback is paused at the mark position during event playback. || appears above the timeline.

CLIP When Clip1 or Clip2 is selected and the mark is registered in the event point, the clip is played back at the mark position during event playback. appears above the timeline.

GPI-Out When a GPI output port from GPI-O1 to GPI-O19 is selected and the mark is registered in the event point, pulse signals are output from the GPI Output port at the mark position during event playback. appears above the timeline. p For the Config menu GPI-Out Port 1/5

sub menu to GPI-Out Port 5/5 sub menu Assign item, check that the selected GPI output port is set to Event MEM.

5Press 6 MOD to register the mark.

In addition, press 4 INS to insert the event.

To cancel the mark registration or event insertion, press the C

UNDO button.

w Setting the event duration

The lengths of the events can be set.

1Use 0/10 << , 1

< , 2 > and .

>> to select the event to be modified.

2Press the SHOT EVENT button to display the Event Memory

menu.

3Use [F1] to display the Event Duration sub menu.

4Use [F2] to set the event length.

5Press [F3] to enter the duration. To cancel what has been modified, press the C

UNDO button.

w Setting the total duration

The total length of all the events from start to end can be set. When the total duration is changed, the durations of the events contained in the event memories are re-calculated using the duration ratio prior to the change. However, the shortest duration of an event cannot be shorter than one frame.

1Press the [EVENT MEM] button and light its indicator.

2Press the [RECALL] button to light its indicator, and use the -/+

PAGE button and number keys (1 to 10) to select the event memory to be modified. Refer to Recalling the operations stored in the

memory (Recall).

3Press the SHOT EVENT button to display the Event Memory

menu.

4Use [F1] to display the Total Duration sub menu.

5Use [F2] to set the event length.

6Press [F3] to enter the duration.

p If no more events can be contained in the total duration which already has many events and which has been changed, the number of frames will be forcibly adjusted.

78

Basic operations

w Setting the event switching effect (Path)

Switching from one event to another (bus switching) can be accomplished smoothly.

1Press the SHOT EVENT button to light its indicator, and display

the Event Memory menu.

2Use [F1] to display the Path sub menu.

3Use [F2] and the Trans Path item to set how transitions to the next event are performed. The following transitions are available:

pWidth of the borders p Soft effect of the borders p Positions of the images p Trimming values

Linear The switching from one image to another is interpolated linearly.

Spline The switching from one image to another is interpolated over a smooth curve (a cubic function curve).

Step The parameters are updated when the events are passed through.

4Use [F3] to select the effect when the colors are switched using the Hue Path item. The following hues are targeted.

p Colors of the color background p Colors of the borders p Colors of the edges p Colors of the fill matte

Short The colors are changed toward less hue on the vectorscope.

Long The colors are changed toward more hue on the vectorscope.

CW The Hue is changed clockwise on the vectorscope.

CCW The Hue is changed counterclockwise on the vectorscope.

Step The color changes are updated when an event is passed through.

Macro memory settings

Recording non-operation periods

1Press the VMEM MACRO button to light its indicator, and display

the Macro menu.

2Use [F1] to display the Insert Delay sub menu.

3Use [F2] to set the time of the non-operation period in the Time item.

4Use [F3] to save the time set in Step 3.

Assigning macro memories

You can assign registered macro memories to the AUX bus crosspoint buttons.

1Press the VMEM MACRO button to light its indicator, and display

the Macro menu.

2Use [F1] to display the Macro Assign1/6 to 6/6 sub menu.

3Use [F2] to [F5] in each of the sub menus to set the macro memories assigned to each crosspoint in the XPT1 to 24 items.

79

Basic operations

Changing macro memory file names

1Press the VMEM MACRO button to light its indicator, and display

the Macro menu.

2Use [F1] to display the Register sub menu.

3Use [F2] and [F3] to select the macro memory whose file name is to be changed.

4Use [F4] and press [F4] in the Rename item. The keyboard screen is displayed, so use it to change the file name of the macro memory.

Registering memories (Register)

Shot memories and event memories can be registered. Information on the memories is displayed in the status area of the built-in display, and names can be changed.

1Press the SHOT EVENT button to light its indicator, and display

the Shot Memory menu (or Event Memory menu). The information of the memories is now displayed in the status area of the built-in display.

2Use [F1] to display the Register sub menu.

Changing the names of the memories

The names (up to 32 characters) of the memories can be changed.

1On the Register sub menu, use [F2] to select the page number of the registered memories using the Page item.

2Use [F3] to select the memory number using the No. item.

3Use [F4] to display the keyboard screen.

4Use the positioner, the number keys, and [F1] to [F3] to enter a name, then press [F4]. To cancel the name which has been input and close the keyboard screen, press [F5]. Refer to Keyboard screen operations.

80

Basic operations

Video memories

This unit can be used to store still image memories (Still) and moving image memories (Clip), each in two channels. 1 channel at a time is saved in 4K mode. pp Images with key signals can be stored in the video memories (still images and moving images). pp The number of seconds that can be saved in the moving image memory depends on the system format. pp The size of the images (number of seconds) which can be stored depends on the system format (frame rate). pp The video memory data can be stored onto, and read out from, memory cards.

Video memory operation

Current status

Clip1 Clip2

Recording Playback Stop Recording Playback Stop

Still1 Recording

Still2 Recording

Clip1

Recording

Playback

Stop

Clip2

Recording

Playback

Stop

: Valid : Invalid

w Video memory input/output The image input materials can be selected from the output signals of the AUX buses (AUX1 to AUX4).

Still2

Still1

Clip2

Clip1

KEYER KeyOut

Fill

Source

Key

Video

Key

Video

Input materials

AUX1 to AUX4: Selected using the menu

81

Basic operations

Recording still images (Still)

1Press the VMEM MACRO button to light its indicator, and display

the Video Memory menu.

2Use [F1] to display the Video Memory1 sub menu.

3Use [F2] to select Still1 or Still2 using the Select item.

p Only Still1 can be selected in the 4K mode.

4Use [F1] to display the Rec2 sub menu.

5Use [F2] to set the images to appear on the built-in display using the Preview item.

On The image appearing on the built-in display is forcibly switched to the image to be recorded (AUX1 to AUX4 selected using the V Source item) instead of the material selected by the DISP bus.

Off The image source selected by the DISP bus is displayed as a preview.

When On is selected for the Preview item, be aware that the following operations will occur:

p The DISP button will link with the AUX bus selection button (AUX BUS DELEGATION) of AUX1 to AUX4 selected in the V Source item, which will light or turn off the buttons. p If the material of the DISP bus is changed, the materials of the DISP bus and the selected AUX bus change at the same time. Similarly, if the material of the selected AUX bus is changed, the material of the DISP bus changes at the same time.

6Use [F2] and [F3] of Rec1 to set the images to be recorded in the video memory in the V Source item.

AUX1 to AUX4

The output signals of the AUX buses (AUX1 to AUX4) are recorded as the material.

7Use [F4] of Rec2 to set the review display in the Review item.

On After the images have been recorded, the images of the video memory recorded in the AUX bus are displayed (for 2 seconds or so).

Off The review display is not shown.

8Use [F1] to display the Video Memory1 sub menu.

9As soon as [F3] (Rec) is pressed, the still images are recorded.

p If the [VMEM] button on the right of the number keys is pressed and the video memory operation mode has been established, the operation of this button is linked with the [XPT/DSBL] button among the number keys. pWhen the recording of the still images is completed, thumbnails of the still images are displayed in the thumbnail screen.

82

Basic operations

Recording moving images (Clip)

1Press the VMEM MACRO button to light its indicator, and display

the Video Memory menu.

2Use [F1] to display the Video Memory1 sub menu.

3Use [F2] to select Clip1 or Clip2 using the Select item.

p Only Clip1 can be selected in the 4K mode.

4Use [F1] to display the Rec2 sub menu.

5Use [F2] to set the images to appear on the built-in display using the Preview item.

On The image appearing on the built-in display is forcibly switched to the image to be recorded (AUX1 to AUX4 selected using the V Source item) instead of the material selected by the DISP bus.

Off The image source selected by the DISP bus is displayed as a preview.

When On is selected for the Preview item, be aware that the following operations will occur:

p The DISP button will link with the AUX bus selection button (AUX BUS DELEGATION) of AUX1 to AUX4 selected in the V Source item, which will light or turn off the buttons. p If the material of the DISP bus is changed, the materials of the DISP bus and the selected AUX bus change at the same time. Similarly, if the material of the selected AUX bus is changed, the material of the DISP bus changes at the same time.

6Use [F2] and [F3] of Rec1 to set the images to be recorded in the video memory in the V Source item.

AUX1 to AUX4

The output signals of the AUX buses (AUX1 to AUX4) are recorded as the material.

7Use [F4] of Rec2 to set the review display in the Review item.

On After the images have been recorded, the images of the video memory recorded in the AUX bus are displayed (up to 4 seconds).

Off The review display is not shown.

8Use [F1] to display the Rec3 sub menu.

9 Use [F2] to select the recording repeat setting using the Loop item.

On The recording of the images is continued until the stop operation is performed. If either of the following operations is performed while recording is in progress, the images are recorded up to the last frame, after which recording stops. p When Off is selected as the Loop item

setting. p When [Stop] ([F5] of Video Memory sub

menu) is pressed.

Off Images are recorded up to the maximum recording time (set using the Limit items), after which recording stops automatically.

Use [F3] to set the quality of the images to be recorded using the Quality item.

Standard Standard image quality

High High image quality

Image quality depends on the video format. Standard High

2160/59.94p 15 seconds High mode will be half the Standard mode.

2160/50p 18 seconds

2160/29.97p (*) 30 seconds

2160/25p (*) 36 seconds

2160/23.98p, 24p (*) 37.5 seconds

1080/59.94p 60 seconds

1080/50p 72 seconds

1080/29.97psf 120 seconds

1080/25psf 144 seconds

1080/23.98psf, 24psf 150 seconds

1080/59.94i 120 seconds

1080/50i 144 seconds

720/59.94p 120 seconds

720/50p 144 seconds

*: Planned support with a firmware update

83

Basic operations

Use [F4] to set the maximum recording time using the Limit item.

Use [F1] to display the Video Memory1 sub menu.

Use [F1] to display the Play Mode2 sub menu.

> Use [F4] to set the sound to be recorded with the Audio item.

As soon as [F3] (Rec) is pressed, the recording of the moving images starts.

When [F5] (Stop) is pressed, the recording of the moving images is stopped.

p If the [VMEM] button on the right of the number keys is pressed and the video memory operation mode has been established, the operation of this button is linked with the -/+

PAGE button among the number keys. p Thumbnails of moving images are displayed on the thumbnail screen. While the thumbnails are displayed, the following information is also displayed on the thumbnail screen.

Current playback position (time), IN point position, OUT point position

pWith the moving images on which the key signals are recorded, a white mark is displayed for the thumbnail icons. p The recording time is displayed in the Total Time item of the Video Memory3 sub menu. However, if trimming has been performed, the time from the IN point to the OUT point after trimming is displayed. Also, On is displayed for the Key item when the key signals have been recorded.

Saving Images in Flash Memory

Data for images stored in the video memory can be retained even when the power is turned off, by saving them in the flash memory area. Whether to automatically save the image data stored in the video memory when the data is transferred from the AUX bus or to manually save them must be set.

pp If power to the unit is turned off when the saving of data has not finished, video memory data will be lost. pp Video memory data that has been saved is always

restored when the power is turned on. pp If the unit is initialized, video memory that has been

saved to flash memory will be lost.

Notes

1Press the VMEM MACRO button to light its indicator, and display

the Video Memory menu.

2Use [F1] to display the Memory sub menu.

3Use [F2] to select the saving method using the Mode item.

Auto Automatic saving

Manual Manual saving

4Use [F3] to select the video memory for saving data in the flash memory area using the Select item. If All is selected, all video memory will be saved. Video memory that has finished being recorded is saved to the flash memory area.

5Press the [F5] (Save) to save data in the flash memory area.

p [F3] (Select) and [F5] (Save) are enabled when Manual is selected for the Mode item. pWhen Auto is selected for the Mode item, if video memory recording is stopped, the video memory is saved to the flash memory area immediately after recording stops. However, if the power is cut off during recording, the video memories will not be saved in the flash memory area.

84

Basic operations

Playing back moving images (Clip)

Establishing the playback mode

1Press the VMEM MACRO button to light its indicator, and display

the Video Memory menu.

2Use [F1] to display the Play Mode1 sub menu (or Play Mode2 sub menu).

3Use [F2] to select the playback mode using the Mode item.

Lead Operation returns to the start frame after playback.

Last Operation stops at the end frame after playback.

Loop The end frame and start frame are joined together and played back repeatedly.

4Use [F3] to select reverse playback using the Reverse item.

On The moving images are played back in the reverse direction.

Off The moving images are played back in the forward direction.

pWhen the [VMEM] button on the right of the number key is pressed and the video memory operation mode has been established, the operation of this button is linked with the 3

REV button among the number keys.

5Use [F4] to select the speed for variable speed playback using the Variable item.

Speeds which can be selected: 1, 2, 4, 8, 1/2, 1/4, 1/8

6Use [F5] to select the image when operation is stopped using the Freeze item.

Frame Stops at the frame image.

Field Stops at the field image.

p Depending on the video format, some formats cannot be selected.

7Use [F1] to display the Play Mode2 sub menu.

8Use [F2] to set the control button used for playing back moving images in tandem with the transition operation. Use [F2] to set the Clip playback start button.

Off Playback is not performed in tandem with the transition operation.

AUTO The playback of the moving images is started in tandem with the operation of the [AUTO] button.

KEY1 ON The playback of the moving images is started in tandem with the operation of the [KEY1 ON] button.

KEY2 ON The playback of the moving images is started in tandem with the operation of the [KEY2 ON] button.

KEY3 ON The playback of the moving images is started in tandem with the operation of the [KEY3 ON] button.

DSK1 ON The playback of the moving images is started in tandem with the operation of the [DSK1 ON] button.

DSK2 ON The playback of the moving images is started in tandem with the operation of the [DSK2 ON] button.

FTB ON The playback of the moving images is started in tandem with the operation of the [FTB ON] button.

Playing back the moving images

1Press the VMEM MACRO button to light its indicator, and display

the Video Memory menu.

2Use [F1] to display the Video Memory1 sub menu.

3Use [F2] to select Clip1 or Clip2 using the Select item.

4When [F4] (Play) is pressed, playback of the moving images is started.

pWhen the [VMEM] button on the right of the number key is pressed and the video memory operation mode has been established, the operation of this button is linked with the [TAKE/ENTER] button among the number keys.

p The current playback position (time) is displayed for the Current Time item on the Video Memory3 sub menu.

85

Basic operations

Moving to the first frame or last frame

1Press the VMEM MACRO button to light its indicator, and display

the Video Memory menu.

2Use [F1] to display the Video Memory2 sub menu.

3When [F2] (LEAD) is pressed, the current position is moved to the first (head) frame; conversely, when [F3] (LAST) is pressed, the current position is moved to the last frame.

Trimming moving images

The position where the playback of the moving images is to start (IN point) and the position when it is to end (OUT point) can be set.

1Press the [VMEM] button on the right of the number keys to establish the video memory operation mode.

2Use [F1] (SELECT) to select Clip1 or Clip2.

3Use the number keys to stop the moving images at the position where the images are to be trimmed (IN point or OUT point).

4Trim the moving images by operating the buttons below.

9 PASTE

TRIM IN

Sets the trimming IN point.

6 MOD

TRIM OUT

Sets the trimming OUT point.

C UNDO

TRIM OFF

Releases the trimming settings.

p Moving images that have been trimmed are played back from the IN point to the OUT point. pWhen moving images are saved to a memory card, only the trimmed portion is saved. p The same position cannot be specified for the IN point and the OUT point. The smallest unit available when trimming is performed is 2 frames.

w Operations performed using the number keys

VMEM

BKGD PATT

XPT DSBL

TAKE ENTER

7 NEW

8 COPY

9 PASTE

4 INS

5 DEL

6 MOD

1 <

2 >

3 REV

0/10 <<

. >>

C UNDO

CAM CONT

KEY PATT

-/+ PAGE

MEMORY / WIPE PATTERN / 10 KEY

STILL 1 STILL 2 TRIM IN REC

CLIP 1 CLIP 2 TRIM OUT

< > REV

<< >> TRIM OFF PLAY

STOP

7 NEW

STILL 1

Selects Still1 as the operation target.

8 COPY

STILL 2

Selects Still2 as the operation target.

4 INS

CLIP 1

Selects Clip1 as the operation target.

5 DEL

CLIP 2

Selects Clip2 as the operation target.

9 PASTE

TRIM IN

Sets the trimming IN point.

6 MOD

TRIM OUT

Sets the trimming OUT point.

C UNDO

TRIM OFF

Releases the trimming settings.

1 < <

Plays back the moving images one frame at a time in the reverse direction.

2 > >

Plays back the moving images one frame at a time in the forward direction.

3 REV REV

Sets the playback direction to reverse. (Button indicator lights: reverse direction; indicator off: forward direction)

0/10 << <<

Transfers to the start frame of the moving images, and stops.

. >> >>

Transfers to the end frame of the moving images, and stops.

TAKE ENTER

PLAY

Plays back the moving images.

XPT DSBL REC

Starts recording the moving images.

-/+ PAGE STOP

Stops the recording or playback of the moving images.

86

Basic operations

Displaying thumbnails

pp When the [VMEM] button located on the right of the number keys is pressed and the video memory operation mode has been established, thumbnails of the images registered in the video memories (Still1, Still2, Clip1, Clip2) can be shown on the built-in display.

Thumbnail layout

w Still (still images)

Still image

Key signal indicator (A key signal is always present for Still) q: No key signal : Key signal present

w Clip (moving images)

Image in the first frame of the clip

Key signal indicator q: No key signal : Key signal present

Duration of the recorded clip

Duration of the range specified with trimming

Current playback position

Trimming IN point Trimming OUT point

Memory card

The units video memory data and setup data can be stored on memory card. Conversely, this data can be loaded from the memory card to the unit. Furthermore, it is possible to upgrade the units software. pp It may take a while to store a moving image of a long

recording time with high image quality or a still image file with high image quality on the memory card. (Approximately 10 minutes is necessary when data with total size of about 490 MB stored in All file is saved to a Panasonic Class 8 SDHC memory card.)

Video memory (still image data: Still1, Still2):

Bitmap (bmp), JPEG (jpg), TARGA (tga), TIFF (tif), GIF (gif), PNG (png)

p This unit supports 24-bit uncompressed or 32-bit uncompressed TARGA files. If any other types of TARGA files are loaded into the unit, black images will be displayed as the thumbnails, and the unit cannot recognize the files. p Be aware that saving video memory still images on the memory card in GIF format will cause the picture quality to deteriorate.

4K: 38402160 HD/1080i: 19201080 HD/1080PsF: 19201080 HD/720p: 1280720

p The size of images is converted automatically if it does not match any of the applicable sizes.

p The pixels of images in SD format are not square, so the aspect ratio will be different when the images are displayed on the computer and when they are imported into video memory (with NTSC format, they will be vertically long). To keep the images true to their actual proportions, make sure the original size is 720540 pixels. If the images are in NTSC format, use images shrunk to 720487 pixels. If the images are in PAL format, use images enlarged to 720576 pixels.

87

Basic operations

Video memories (moving image data: Clip1, Clip2): This is the original format of the unit. Data is stored in and read from these memories.

Shot memory data (Shot): Data is stored in and read from these memories.

Event memory data (Event): Data is stored in and read from these memories.

Setup data (Set Up): The setup data refers to all the data stored in the unit with the exception of the following data. Project files can be saved.

Date, time, network settings, video memory data, shot memory data, event memory data

Plug-in software (Plug-in): The plug-in software data is loaded. It cannot be stored.

Software for upgrading (Upgrade): The software for upgrading is loaded. This software can be obtained from Service and Support on the Web site whose address is provided below:

https://pro-av.panasonic.net/

For the upgrade procedure, follow the steps in the directions which are contained in the download file.

Log file (Log): Log files stored in the unit can be saved.

pqConcerning memory cards Memory cards used with the unit should conform to SD, SDHC or SDXC standards. Be sure to format cards using the unit. Use SD cards formatted with FAT. (NTFS formatted SD cards cannot be recognized.) Panasonic memory cards with the following capacities can be used with the unit:

SD (from 8 MB to 2 GB) SDHC (from 4 GB to 32 GB) SDXC (*) (from 64 GB to 128 GB)

*: Planned support with a firmware update

For the latest information not available in the Operating Instructions, visit the following Web sites.

https://pro-av.panasonic.net/

pp Memory cards must not be used or stored in an environment where they may be

Exposed to high temperatures/humidities; Exposed to water droplets; or Electrically charged.

88

Basic operations

The data is stored in the following folders on the memory card. When data is to be loaded, first store the data in the respective folders, and then load the files.

Data type Save Type item Storage folder Extension

Project file (project) Project (*2) HS\COMM\PROJECT 001, 002, (*3)

Video memory (Still file) Still1, Still2 (*1) HS\COMM\IMAGE bmp, tga, png, jpg (jpeg), tif (tiff), gif

Thumbnail image for video memory (Still file)

Still1, Still2 (*1) HS\COMM\IMAGE_THUMBNAIL tbm, tpn, tjp, ttg, ttif, tgi

Video memory (Clip file) Clip1, Clip2 (*1) HS\COMM\CLIP clp

Thumbnail image for video memory (Clip file)

Clip1, Clip2 (*1) HS\COMM\CLIP_THUMBNAIL png

Update file HS\UHS500\UPDATE 50d

Log file Log HS\UHS500\LOG log

*1: When the still image data with key signals attached is stored into the video memory, select tga or png as the file format. The still image data of any other file format cannot be stored with attaching the key signals. In 4K mode, only Still1 and Clip1 are available.

*2: The project file is a collection of data selected in the Target Select item; setup data, shot memory data, event memory data, macro memory data, still image data, and moving image data.

*3: The project file is saved in a folder created as File Name folder created under the HS\COMM\PROJECT folder. When the project file being stored is large, the file is divided and each file is appended with a serial number extension (001, 002, etc.).

Memory card handling precautions p Do NOT eject the memory card while the memory card access LED is lit. When an memory card is ejected while the memory card access LED is lit, the transition may be temporarily suspended.

In addition, the data stored on the memory card may be lost. p The data stored on memory cards may be lost as a result of misplacing the cards or performing erroneous operations, for

instance. It is recommended that valuable data be stored on a computer or other device.

89

Basic operations

Initializing the memory cards

Before an memory card is used in this unit, the card must be initialized by the unit without fail.

By initializing the memory card formats (in compliance with the SD standard) it creates the dedicated directory. (All files saved on the memory card will be erased.)

1Insert the memory card into the units memory card slot.

2Press the PRJ SD Card button to light its indicator, and display

the SD Card menu.

3Use [F1] to display the Card Management sub menu.

4Use [F5] to execute the Format item. The item is grayed out if a memory card is not inserted.

p Press [F1] in the confirmation screen to format. p Press [F5] to cancel.

Before using a memory card in this unit, initialize it. This unit also supports SDHC/SDXC (*) memory cards. Memory cards can be initialized no matter whether they are SD or SDHC/SDXC (*) memory cards.

*: Planned support with a firmware update

Saving data on memory cards

1Insert the memory card which has been initialized by the unit, into the memory card slot.

2Press the PRJ SD Card button to light its indicator, and display

the SD Card menu.

3Use [F1] to display the File sub menu.

4Use [F3] to select the data to save to the memory card in the Save Type item.

When saving still images: Use [F4] to select the saving file format of still images in the File Format item.

When saving project files: Use [F1] to select the item you want to save as the project file in the Target Select1/2 item. Use [F2] to [F5] to set each of the items be saved to ON.

5If the [F5] (Save) is now pressed, the file is stored on the memory card.

For the destinations where the data is stored, refer to .

pWhen storing video memory still images, the file format can be selected. On the SD Card menu, use [F1] to display the File2 sub menu, and select the format of the file to be used when storing the data on the memory card using the Format item. p Be aware that saving video memory still images on the memory card in GIF format will cause the picture quality to deteriorate.

90

Basic operations

Loading data from memory cards

1Insert the memory card on which the data is stored into the memory card slot. Load the file after its data has been stored in the each folder. Data stored in other folders will not be recognized by the unit.

For the destinations where the data is stored, refer to .

2On the SD Card menu, use [F1] to display the Mode sub menu.

3Use [F2], and then press the [F2] using the Load item. When [F2] is pressed, the file selection screen is displayed.

4Use [F1] to select the type of file to be loaded using the SELECT item.

p Correlation between [F1] (for selecting a setting using the SELECT item) and [F3] on the file selection screen

[F1] Settings selected

using SELECT item

[F3] Displays and function

Still1, Still2, Clip1, Clip2

F3: LIST VIEW Using the [F3], it is possible to switch the screen display between List (list files) and Thumbnail (display thumbnails). pp Only Still1 and Clip1 can be selected in the 4K mode.

Upgrade F3: The [F3] cannot be operated. On the screen, the list of files is displayed.

Project F3: The [F3] cannot be operated. On the screen, the list of files is displayed.

5Use [F2] to select the name of the file to be loaded using the SELECT FILE item. If the name of the file to be loaded consists of more than 23 characters, a shortened version of the filename will be displayed.

p The following alphanumerics and symbols can be used as the characters for filenames (see below). Files using other characters will not be displayed by the unit. p Periods are not available in the input screen. Characters that are not available in the keyboard screen are grayed out.

A to Z, a to z, 0 to 9, ! # $ % & ' ( ) - . @ ^ _ ` { }

6Use [F4] to load the file.

Thumbnail display

For Still thumbnails, the image is displayed in the upper portion, and the file name, KEY indicator, image size, and file date are displayed in the lower portion. For Clip thumbnails, a still image is displayed in the upper portion, and the file name, KEY indicator, recorded time (number of frames), format, and file date are displayed in the lower portion. A maximum of up to 100 Still thumbnails and 100 Clip thumbnails can be displayed. On a single screen, 8 thumbnails are displayed in 2 rows of 4 thumbnails each. For more than 8 thumbnails, thumbnails are switched one row at a time. When moving the cursor with [F2] (the SELECT item), if the cursor is at the image in the lower-right corner (or upper-left corner), moving to the right (or left) switches pages. pp Never remove the memory card while thumbnail display is

in progress.

91

Basic operations

Changing the sort mode

The way in which the file list displayed on the file selection screen is arranged can be specified.

1On the SD Card menu, use [F1] to display the Mode sub menu.

2Use [F5] to select the sort mode for the file selection screen using the Sort item.

Newest The files are arranged in sequence starting with the file having the most recent registration date and time.

Oldest The files are arranged in sequence starting with the file having the oldest registration date and time.

Name The files are arranged in filename sequence.

Deleting files on memory cards

1Insert the memory card on which the data is stored into the memory card slot.

2On the SD Card menu, use [F1] to display the Mode sub menu.

3Use [F3] to select Delete using the Mode item, and then press the [F3]. When [F3] is pressed, the file selection screen is displayed.

4Use [F1] to select the type of file to be deleted using the SELECT item. If the name of the file to be loaded consists of more than 23 characters, a shortened version of the filename will be displayed.

5Use [F2] to select the name of the file to be deleted using the SELECT FILE item.

6Use [F4] to delete the file.

92

Basic operations

Displaying the memory card information

1Insert the memory card on which the data is stored into the memory card slot.

2On the SD Card menu, use [F1] to display the Card Information sub menu.

Free The memory cards remaining free space is displayed.

Total The memory cards capacity is displayed.

Creating thumbnail images

1Insert the memory card on which the data is stored into the memory card slot.

2On the SD Card menu, use [F1] to display the Create Thumbnail sub menu.

3Use [F2] to create the thumbnail for still images in the Still item.

4Use [F3] to create the thumbnail for moving images in the Clip item.

93

Basic operations

Waveform monitor settings

WFM (waveform monitor) settings

1Press the [WFM/VECT] button among the display mode buttons to display the waveform monitor on the built-in display.

2Press the CONF SYS button to light its indicator, and display

the Config menu.

3Use [F1] to display the WFM sub menu.

4Use [F2] to select the method to be used to display the signal waveforms using the Style item.

Parade The signal waveforms are arranged and displayed.

Overlay The signal waveforms are superimposed onto each other and displayed.

5Use [F3] to select the signals whose waveforms are to be displayed using the Mode item.

YPbPr Waveforms of the Y, PB and PR signals are displayed.

RGB Waveforms of the R, G and B signals are displayed.

Y Waveforms of the Y signal only are displayed.

VECTOR (vectorscope) settings

1Press the [WFM/VECT] button among the display mode buttons to display the vectorscope on the built-in display.

2Press the CONF SYS button to light its indicator, and display

the Config menu.

3Use [F1] to display the Vector sub menu.

4Use [F2] to select the color bar reference marker using the Bar Target item.

75% The 75% color bar reference marker is displayed.

100% The 100% color bar reference marker is displayed.

94

Input/output signal settings

Input signal settings

IN1 and IN2 are exclusive input by SDI signals or HDMI signals. SDI IN3 to 8 are SDI signal inputs. IN-A1 to 4, IN-B1 to 4 can be set only when one of the following optional units has been connected.

AV-UHS5M1 (SDI Input Unit) IN-A1 to A4 and IN-B1 to B4 can be set.

AV-UHS5M3 (HDMI Input Unit) IN-A1 to A3 and IN-B1 to B3 can be set.

Before setting the input signals, first select the input signal to be set using the Input sub menu.

1Press the IN OUT button to light its indicator, and display the Input menu.

2Use [F1] to display the Input sub menu.

3Use [F2] to select the input signals using the Select item.

The menu display is switched in accordance with the input signals which have been selected. The menu title is set to MENU: Input (signal type)/input connector (material name).

Signal type SDI, HDMI

Material name Material name set in Setting the material names.

95

Input/output signal settings

Input connector

Setting menu and page in this manual

Color Space Status FS Freeze Limited Name

P 96 P 97 P 97 P 98 P 98 P 99

12G SDI IN1, 12G SDI IN2 HDMI IN1, HDMI IN2

Exclusionary input

Standard SDI input 2 lines

Standard HDMI input 2 lines

12G SDI IN3, 12G SDI IN4

Standard SDI input 2 lines

12G SDI IN5 to 12G SDI IN8

Standard SDI input 4 lines

Option slot IN-A1 to IN-A4 IN-B1 to IN-B4

AV-UHS5M1

SDI input 4 lines

Option slot IN-A1 to IN-A3 IN-B1 to IN-B3

AV-UHS5M3

HDMI input 3 lines

Input connector

Setting menu and page in this manual

Up/Down Converter

C/C HDMI Status HDMI Input Scale Camera Settings

P 99 P 100 P 104 P 103 P 108 P 128

12G SDI IN1, 12G SDI IN2 HDMI IN1, HDMI IN2

Exclusionary input

Standard SDI input 2 lines

Standard HDMI input 2 lines

12G SDI IN3, 12G SDI IN4

Standard SDI input 2 lines

12G SDI IN5 to 12G SDI IN8

Standard SDI input 4 lines

Option slot IN-A1 to IN-A4 IN-B1 to IN-B4

AV-UHS5M1

SDI input 4 lines

Option slot IN-A1 to IN-A3 IN-B1 to IN-B3

AV-UHS5M3

HDMI input 3 lines

: Can be set. : Cannot be set.

96

Input/output signal settings

Settings for the exclusionary input connectors

Set the exclusionary input for the SDI input connectors (12G SDI IN1, 12G SDI IN2)/HDMI input connectors (HDMI IN1, HDMI IN2). These settings are for IN1 and IN2 which can be selected in the Select item of the Input sub menu.

1Press the IN OUT button to light its indicator, and display

the Input menu.

2Use [F1] to display the Input sub menu.

3Use [F2] to select the input signals using the Select item.

4Use [F5] to set the input signal type in the SDI/HDMI item.

SDI IN Selects the SDI signal input to 12G SDI IN1/2 for IN1/2. Even if HDMI signals are input, they are not input to this unit.

HDMI IN Selects the HDMI signal input to HDMI IN1/2 for IN1/2. Even if SDI signals are input, they are not input to this unit.

Settings for the color range for input signals

Set the color range for input signals. You can set all input signals independently.

1Press the IN OUT button to light its indicator, and display

the Input menu.

2Use [F1] to display the Input sub menu.

3Use [F2] to select the input signals using the Select item.

4Use [F4] to set the color range in the Color Space item.

HDR BT.2020 High dynamic range, color range entered is Rec.2020.

HDR BT.709 High dynamic range, color range entered is Rec.709.

SDR BT.709 Standard dynamic range, color range entered is Rec.709.

97

Input/output signal settings

Checking the input signal status

You can check the status of input signals.

For SDI input signals

1Use [F1] to display the Status sub menu.

The unit automatically determines the content of input signals and displays the following information.

Format Displays the image format information for the SDI signal being input.

Audio Displays the audio information for the SDI signal being input.

Color Space Displays the color space information for the SDI signal being input.

For HDMI input signals

1Use [F1] to display the HDMI Status sub menu.

The unit automatically determines the content of input signals and displays the following information.

Size Displays the resolution information for the HDMI signal being input.

Dot Clock Displays the dot clock information for the HDMI signal being input.

H-Frequency Displays the horizontal frequency information for the HDMI signal being input.

V-Frequency Displays the vertical frequency information for the HDMI signal being input.

Setting the frame synchronizer

The frame synchronizer can be set to On or Off for each input. The HDMI input frame synchronizer is permanently On. It cannot be set from On to Off or vice versa.

1On the Input sub menu, use [F2] to select the input to be set using the Select item. Refer to Input signal settings.

2Use [F1] to display the FS sub menu.

3Use [F3] to set the frame synchronizer in the FS item.

Off Turns the frame synchronizer Off. The line synchronizer function operates in this case. The line synchronizer function automatically adjusts the phases of input video signals to match the phases of the horizontal sync signals.

Normal Enables the frame synchronizer function. When a signal that is different from the system format is input, the screen turns black.

Auto Enables the frame synchronizer function. Even when a signal that is different from the system format is input, the screen does not turn black. The video output in this case may be disrupted.

p If the output signal phase is set to [0H], Off cannot be selected as the FS item setting. pWhen inputting 3G-SDI Level B Mapping signals, set the frame synchronizer setting to [Auto].

98

Input/output signal settings

Setting the delay amount

The input signals can be delayed. pp This setting is for input signals to 12G SDI IN5 to 8 and the

optional SDI input unit (IN-A1 to 4 and IN-B1 to 4).

1On the Input sub menu, use [F2] to select the input to be set using the Select item. Refer to Input signal settings.

2Use [F1] to display the FS sub menu.

3Use [F3] to set the delay amount using the Delay item.

Freezing the input signals

The input signals can be frozen and used. While signals are frozen, the tally signals of the corresponding input will not be output.

Setting freeze

1On the Input sub menu, use [F2] to select the input to be set using the Select item. Refer to Input signal settings.

2Use [F1] to display the Freeze sub menu.

Frame The images are frozen frame by frame.

Field The images are frozen field by field. This is used to freeze moving images. With interlace signals, however, diagonal lines and moving parts appear jagged.

Frame or Field can also be selected while an image is frozen.

3Press the [F3] to freeze the input image or cancel the freeze.

If the [F3] is pressed while the display is Off, the video signal is frozen, and the display is set to On.

If the [F3] is pressed while the display is On, the video signal freezing is canceled, and the display is set to Off.

The F mark appears in front of the name of the material when the signals set for output of multi view displays are frozen.

pWhen the unit is used with the frame synchronizer function OFF, the output images may be disturbed when freezing is executed, but the frozen images will not be adversely affected. p If, when the switcher is used with the frame synchronizer function at OFF, On is set as the freeze setting, the frame synchronizer function will be automatically switched to ON.

99

Input/output signal settings

Setting the material names

Material names can be given to the input signals. These names can be selected from the default settings or user settings.

1On the Input sub menu, use [F2] to select the input to be set using the Select item. Refer to Input signal settings.

2Use [F1] to display the Name sub menu.

3Use [F2] to select the type of material names using the Type item.

Default (default settings)

Select the material names from the following: IN1, IN2, 12G SDI IN3 to 8, IN-A1 to 4, IN-B1 to 4

User (user settings)

The material names are set using up to 32 characters.

Setting the up-converter

Select the settings for SDI IN5 to SDI IN8, as well as for the up-converter that is built into the optional unit listed below:

p AV-UHS5M1 (SDI Input Unit)

1On the Input sub menu, use [F2] to select the input to be set using the Select item. Refer to Input signal settings.

2Use [F1] to display the Up/Down Converter sub menu.

3Use [F2] to set the image movement detection sensitivity using the Move Detect item.

1 Toward still images

3 Standard

5 Toward moving images

4Use [F3] to set the extent of the edge sharpness for the images using the Sharp item.

1 Not sharp edges

3 Standard

5 Very sharp edges

100

Input/output signal settings

Color Corrector

Make settings for the Color Correctors built in to SDI IN5 to SDI IN8 and the following optional units.

1On the Input sub menu, use [F2] to select the input to be set using the Select item. Refer to Input signal settings.

Color Corrector settings

1Use [F1] to display the C/C Operation sub menu.

2Use [F2] to set the Color Corrector to enable (On)/ disable (Off).

3Use [F3] to set the color range of the input signal in the Limit item.

Off No limit on color range.

108 The amplitude level of each color (R, G, B) is limited to between 0% and 108%.

104 The amplitude level of each color (R, G, B) is limited to between 0% and 104%.

100 The amplitude level of each color (R, G, B) is limited to between 0% and 100%.

Process control

1Use [F1] to display the C/C Process sub menu.

2Use [F2] to set the gain value of the Y signal in the Y-Gain item.

3Use [F3] to set the value of the pedestal level in the Pedestal item.

4Use [F4] to set the gain value of the saturation in the C-Gain item.

5Use [F5] to set the amount of change of the color hue in the Hue item.

Tone curve

Corrects the tone of the input signal. Set the tone curve to adjust the brightness, contrast, etc., of images. You can adjust the white balance and the color tone by separately adjusting each of the R, G, and B colors.

Tone1 Black Tone2 Gray L Tone3 Gray H Tone4 White

Tone1 Black Adjusts the black level.

Tone2 Gray L Adjusts the gray Low level.

Tone3 Gray H Adjusts the gray High level.

Tone4 White Adjusts the white level.

1Use [F1] to display the C/C Tone1 Black sub menu.

2Use [F2] to adjust the R signal of the black level in the Red item.

3Use [F3] to adjust the G signal of the black level in the Green item.

4Use [F4] to adjust the B signal of the black level in the Blue item.

5Use [F5] to make the link settings for the adjustment value in the RGB Link item.

Off RGB can be independently set in each of the C/C Tone1 Black, C/C Tone2 Gray L, C/C Tone3 Gray H, and C/C Tone4 White sub menus.

On The Red setting value is set in Green and Blue in each of the C/C Tone1 Black, C/C Tone2 Gray L, C/C Tone3 Gray H, and C/C Tone4 White sub menus.

101

Input/output signal settings

6Use [F1] to display the C/C Tone2 Gray L sub menu.

7Use [F2] to adjust the R signal of the Gray Low level in the Red item.

8Use [F3] to adjust the G signal of the Gray Low level in the Green item.

9Use [F4] to adjust the B signal of the Gray Low level in the Blue item.

Use [F1] to display the C/C Tone3 Gray H sub menu.

Use [F2] to adjust the Gray High level of the R signal in the Red item.

Use [F3] to adjust the Gray High level of the G signal in the Green item.

Use [F4] to adjust the Gray High level of the B signal in the Blue item.

> Use [F1] to display the C/C Tone4 White sub menu.

Use [F2] to adjust the R signal of the white level in the Red item.

Use [F3] to adjust the G signal of the white level in the Green item.

Use [F4] to adjust the B signal of the white level in the Blue item.

pp The unit joins the set black level, gray Low level, gray High level, and white level with a simplified curve to create a tone curve. The desired tone curve may not be achieved, depending on the setting values.

Note

Gain adjustments for the color matrix

1Use [F1] to display the C/C Matrix R/G sub menu.

2Use [F2] to set the gain value of the R-G axial direction in the R-G item.

3Use [F3] to set the gain value of the R-B axial direction in the R-B item.

4Use [F4] to set the gain value of the G-R axial direction in the G-R item.

5Use [F5] to set the gain value of the G-B axial direction in the G-B item.

6Use [F1] to display the C/C Matrix B sub menu.

7Use [F2] to set the gain value of the B-R axial direction in the B-R item.

8Use [F3] to set the gain value of the B-G axial direction in the B-G item.

102

Input/output signal settings

Initializing the color corrector

1Use [F1] to display the C/C Setting sub menu.

2Use [F2] to select the initialization target in the Init Target item.

Process The settings in the C/C Process sub menu are initialized.

Tone The settings in the C/C Tone1 Black, C/C Tone2 Gray L, C/C Tone3 Gray H, and C/C Tone4 White sub menu are initialized.

RGB Matrix The settings in the C/C Matrix R/G and C/C Matrix B sub menu are initialized.

All All are initialized.

Copying settings

You can copy the Color Corrector setting information that was set for another input.

1Use [F1] to display the C/C Setting sub menu.

2Use [F4] to select the copy target in the Copy Target item.

3When the Copy From item in [F5] is pressed, the settings selected as the Copy Target are copied.

103

Input/output signal settings

Setting the HDMI input signals

Set the HDMI input signals when the HDMI input unit (optional) or full-HD HDMI input unit (optional) has been connected. Signals with the following resolutions can be input.

HDMI input signals Standard (Digital)

HDMI Input Unit (Digital)

AV-UHS5M3

XGA (1024768)/60 Hz

WXGA (1280768)/60 Hz

SXGA (12801024)/60 Hz

WSXGA+ (16801050)/60 Hz

UXGA (16001200)/60 Hz

WUXGA (19201200)/60 Hz

WQHD (25601440)/60 Hz

720/59.94p (19201080)/59.94 Hz

720/50p (19201080)/50 Hz

1080/59.94i (19201080)/59.94 Hz

1080/50i (19201080)/50 Hz

1080/23.98p (19201080)/23.98 Hz

1080/25p (19201080)/25 Hz

1080/29.97p (19201080)/29.97 Hz

1080/59.94p (19201080)/59.94 Hz

1080/50p (19201080)/50 Hz

2160/59.94p (38402160)/59.94 Hz

2160/50p (38402160)/50 Hz

: Can be set. : Cannot be set.

pp If signals with any other resolutions or frequencies are input, the signals cannot be imported correctly. The images which are output at a time like this may be black or disturbed. pp These units are incompatible with the HDCP (High-

bandwidth Digital Content Protection).

1On the Input sub menu, use [F2] to select the input to be set using the Select item. Refer to Input signal settings.

2Use [F1] to display the HDMI Input sub menu.

3Use [F2] to select the scaling method.

Fit-V The aspect ratio of the input images is maintained, and the size of the images is increased or reduced in accordance with the vertical resolution.

Fit-H The aspect ratio of the input images is maintained, and the size of the images is increased or reduced in accordance with the horizontal resolution.

Full The size of the input images is increased or reduced in accordance with the system resolution. (The aspect ratio of the input images is not kept the same. The rate at which the image size is increased or reduced in the vertical direction and in the horizontal direction differs.)

104

Input/output signal settings

Displaying the HDMI input signal information

These are used to display the information concerning the HDMI input signal images. The information cannot be changed.

1On the Input sub menu, use [F2] to select the input to be set using the Select item. Refer to Input signal settings.

2Use [F1] to display the HDMI Status sub menu.

Size This indicates the pixel count of the images.

Dot Clock This indicates the dot clock frequency of the images.

H-Frequency This indicates the horizontal frequency of the images.

V-Frequency This indicates the vertical frequency of the images.

The formats supported are listed below.

HDMI input signal Dot clock frequency

(MHz)

Frequency

Horizontal (kHz)

Vertical (Hz)

XGA 1024768 Digital 65.0 48.36 60.00

WXGA 1280768 Digital 79.5 47.78 59.87

SXGA 12801024 Digital 108.0 63.98 60.02

WSXGA+ 16801050 Digital 146.2 65.29 59.95

UXGA 16001200 Digital 162.0 75.00 60.00

WUXGA 19201200 Digital 154.0 74.04 59.95

WQHD 25601440 Digital 241.5 88.79 59.95

720/59.94p 19201080 Digital 74.25/1.001 44.96 60.00/1.001

720/50p 19201080 Digital 74.25 37.50 50.00

1080/59.94i 19201080 Digital 74.25/1.001 33.72 60.00/1.001

1080/50i 19201080 Digital 74.25 28.13 50.00

1080/23.98p 19201080 Digital 74.2 27.0 24.00

1080/24p 19201080 Digital 74.2 27.0 24.00

1080/25p 19201080 Digital 74.2 28.1 25.00

1080/29.97p 19201080 Digital 74.2 33.7 30.00

1080/59.94p 19201080 Digital 148.5/1.001 67.50/1.001 60.00/1.001

1080/50p 19201080 Digital 148.5 56.25 50.00

2160/59.94p 38402160 Digital 594.0/1.001 134.9 60.00/1.001

2160/50p 38402160 Digital 594.0 112.5 50.00

pp If the format of the input signals is not supported, it may not be possible to import the signals properly, and a black image or disturbed image may appear.

105

Input/output signal settings

Output signal settings

12G SDI OUT1 to 12G SDI OUT5 are SDI signal outputs. HDMI OUT1, HDMI OUT2 is HDMI signal output. OUT-A1 to OUT-A4, OUT-B1 to OUT-B4 can be set only when one of the following optional units has been connected.

AV-UHS5M2 (SDI Output Unit) OUT-A1 to A4 and OUT-B1 to B4 can be set.

AV-UHS5M4 (HDMI Output Unit) OUT-A1 to A3 and OUT-B1 to B3 can be set.

Before proceeding to set the output signals, first select the output signals to be set using the Output sub menu.

1Press the IN OUT button to light its indicator, and display the Output menu.

2Use [F1] to display the Output sub menu.

3Use [F2] to select the output signals using the Select item.

The menu display is switched depending on the selected output signals. The menu title is set to MENU: Output (signal type)/output connector.

Signal type SDI, HDMI

Output connector

Setting menu and page in this manual

Assign SDI Output HDMI Output Down

Converter Scale

P 106 P 106 P 107 P 108 P 108

12G SDI OUT1 to 12G SDI OUT5

Standard SDI output 5 lines

Simplified

HDMI OUT1, HDMI OUT2

Standard HDMI output 2 lines

OUT-A1 to OUT-A4 AV-UHS5M2

SDI output 4 lines

OUT-A1 to OUT-A3 AV-UHS5M4

HDMI output 3 lines

OUT-B1 to OUT-B4 AV-UHS5M2

SDI output 4 lines

OUT-B1 to OUT-B3 AV-UHS5M4

HDMI output 3 lines

: Can be set. : Cannot be set.

106

Input/output signal settings

Assigning the output signals

The output signals can be assigned to the 12G SDI OUT connector and HDMI OUT connector.

1On the Output sub menu, use [F2] to select the output to be set using the Select item. Refer to Output signal settings.

2Use [F1] to display the Assign sub menu.

3Use [F2] to set the type of output signal using the Source item.

PGM An image provided with the wipe, mix, key, downstream key or other effect is output at the switchers main line output.

PVW This is the preview output that enables the next operation to be checked before it is executed.

CLN The clean signal (the image resulting when the key, downstream key or other effect has been removed from the PGM signal) is output.

ME PGM ME PGM signals (images without the downstream key effects) are output.

AUX1 to 4 The signals selected by the 4 lines of AUX buses (AUX1 to AUX4) are output.

MV1, MV2 The multi view display signals are output. Multiple input signals and output signals are reduced in size and output to one screen.

KeyOut The key signal is output.

4Use [F3] to set the output mode using the Mode item.

Normal The same signals as the system format signals are output.

Simplified down- converter

When the system format is 2160/59.94p, the signals are output in the 1080/59.94p format.

Down- converter

This can be selected when the SDI output unit (optional: AV-UHS5M1) has been connected. When the system format is 2160/59.94p, the signals are output in the 1080/59.94p, 1080/59.94i or 720/59.94p format. When the system format is 1080/59.94p, the signals are output in the 1080/59.94i or 720/59.94p format. When the system format is 1080/59.94i, the signals are output in the 720/59.94p format.

Setting the SDI output color range

The color range can be set for the SDI output signal images. pp You can set all output signals independently.

1On the Output sub menu, use [F4] to set Color Space.

HDR BT.2020 High dynamic range, color range output is Rec.2020.

HDR BT.709 High dynamic range, color range output is Rec.709.

SDR BT.709 Standard dynamic range, color range output is Rec.709.

107

Input/output signal settings

Setting the HDMI output signals

Set the HDMI output signals of the standard output (HDMI OUT) and the HDMI output signals if the HDMI output unit (optional) has been connected.

1On the Output sub menu, use [F2] to select the output to be set using the Select item. Refer to Output signal settings.

2From the Output sub menu, use [F4] to set the output color range in the Color Space item.

HDR BT.2020 High dynamic range, color range output is Rec.2020.

HDR BT.709 High dynamic range, color range output is Rec.709.

SDR BT.709 Standard dynamic range, color range output is Rec.709.

3Use [F1] to display the Assign sub menu.

4Use [F2] to set the type of output signal using the Source item.

PGM An image provided with the wipe, mix, key, downstream key or other effect is output at the switchers main line output.

PVW This is the preview output that enables the next operation to be checked before it is executed.

CLN The clean signal (the image resulting when the key, downstream key or other effect has been removed from the PGM signal) is output.

ME PGM ME PGM signals (images without the downstream key effects) are output.

AUX1 to 4 The signals selected by the 4 lines of AUX buses (AUX1 to AUX4) are output.

MV1, MV2 The multi view display signals are output. Multiple input signals and output signals are reduced in size and output to one screen.

KeyOut The key signal is output.

The settings below are possible when an HDMI Output Unit (optional) is connected.

5Use [F1] to display the HDMI Output sub menu.

6Use [F2] to select the resolution of the images to be output using the Size item.

Auto The equipment information of the output destination is captured by the HDMI signals, and the images are output at the optimum resolution.

XGA (1024 768) / 60 Hz

WXGA (1280 768) / 60 Hz

SXGA (1280 1024) / 60 Hz

WXGA+ (1680 1050) / 60 Hz

UXGA (1600 1200) / 60 Hz

WUXGA (1920 1200) / 60 Hz

WQHD (2560 1440) / 60 Hz

Native Same format as the system format is output.

7Use [F3] to set the output color space in the Color item.

Auto Device information about the connection destination is obtained via the HDMI signal, and output uses the optimum color space accordingly.

RGB The color space is set with the RGB format.

YUV444 The color space is set with the Y, Cb, Cr at 4:4:4. (With this method, for each 4 horizontal pixels, 4 pixels each are sampled of the luminance component and 2 color difference components)

YUV422 The color space is set with the Y, Cb, Cr at 4:2:2. (With this method, for each 2 horizontal pixels, 1 pixel each is sampled of the color difference components, and each pixel is sampled of the luminance component)

108

Input/output signal settings

8Use [F4] to select the scaling method using the Scale item.

Fit-V The aspect ratio of the output images is maintained, and the size of the images is increased or reduced in accordance with the vertical resolution. (Black bands are inserted into the areas where there are no images. The protruding parts of the images are cropped.)

Fit-H The aspect ratio of the output images is maintained, and the size of the images is increased or reduced in accordance with the horizontal resolution. (Black bands are inserted into the areas where there are no images. The protruding parts of the images are cropped.)

Full The size of the output images is increased or reduced in accordance with the system resolution.

Fullx80% The size of the output image is increased or reduced in accordance with the 80% size of the system resolution.

Fullx90% The size of the output image is increased or reduced in accordance with the 90% size of the system resolution.

p The aspect ratio is not maintained at the Full, Fullx80% or Fullx90% setting. The rate at which the image size is increased or reduced in the vertical direction and in the horizontal direction differs.

9Use [F5] to set the image movement detection sensitivity using the Move Detect item.

1 Toward still images

3 Standard

5 Toward moving images

Setting the down-converter (optional)

Select the settings for the down-converter that is built into the SDI output unit (AV-UHS5M2).

1On the Output sub menu, use [F2] to select the output to be set using the Select item. Refer to Output signal settings.

2Use [F1] to display the Down Converter sub menu.

3Use [F2] to set the delay time of the output using the Delay item.

Minimum Output is with the minimum delay of the system. Refer to "Adjusting the output signal phase" for the size of phase delays.

1F Fix The image is output in-phase with a delay of 1 frame from the system image (HD).

4Use [F3] to set the extent of the edge sharpness for the images using the Sharp item.

1 Standard

5 Very sharp edges

109

Input/output signal settings

Setting the sync signals

The sync signals to be used by the system can be selected. External sync: For synchronization with an external sync signal

(gen-lock). The reference input signal is looped through and output.

BB Black burst signal (vertical phase of 0H)

BB Advanced

Black burst signal Vertical phase of 90H when the 59.94i or 59.94p format is selected; vertical phase of 75H when the 50i or 50p format is selected

Tri-level sync Tri-level sync signal (vertical phase of 0H)

Internal For synchronization with an internal reference signal (INT). The REFOUT signal (black burst signal) is output from the two reference connectors. p This cannot be selected when the system

format is 1080/24PsF.

pWhen the format is 1080/24PsF, only Tri-level sync can be selected.

p This unit supports synchronization signals for field frequencies that are same as those of the system format. When the unit is set to the 1080/23.98PsF format, however, the unit also supports black burst signals with 10F-1D (compliant with the SMPTE318M standard).

1Press the CONF SYS button to light its indicator, and display

the System menu.

2Use [F1] to display the Reference sub menu.

3Use [F2], select the sync signal using the Sync item, and press the [F2] to enter the selection.

4Use [F3] to select the setup level of the black burst signal in the internal synchronization mode using the BB Setup item. This setting takes effect when the video system is 59.94i or 59.94p. The setup level is fixed at 0 IRE when the system is 50i or 50p.

5The genlock status is displayed in the Gen Lock item.

Locked Synchronized with the external sync signal or internal reference signal.

UnLock Not synchronized with the external sync signal or internal reference signal.

Adjusting the output signal phase

The phase of the output video signals can be adjusted.

1Press the CONF SYS button to light its indicator, and display

the System menu.

2Use [F1] to display the Output Phase sub menu.

3Use [F2], and select 0H or 1H using the System item.

0H The output video signals are output to the system Reference signal with using in-phase. The frame synchronizer function is ON for all input signals.

1H The output video signals are output to the system Reference signal with 1H delay. When the frame synchronizer function is ON, the output video signals are output with 1 frame + 1H delay.

4Use [F3] to adjust H phase using the H-Phase item. H-Phase can be adjusted within a range of 0.50H to +0.49H.

p The setting displayed on the menu differs depending on the system format.

5Use [F4] to adjust V phase using the V-Phase item. V-Phase can be adjusted within a range of 100H to +100H.

110

Input/output signal settings

Reference (Phase Reference)

H Phase (0.5H to +0.5H) + V Phase (100 lines)

Internal Fixed DL

Approx. 0.2H

0H Output (1F delay for Reference and in-phase output)

FS Range

MAX less than approximately 1 frame

Longest Output (+1.5H)

Approx. 0.3H

+0.5H

Output Phase Variable Range

Output Phase Variable Range

H Phase (0.5H to +0.5H) + V Phase (100 lines)

Approx. +0.3H to +1.3H Internal Fixed DL

Line Synchronizer Range

Reference (System standard)

1H Output (+1H)

Shortest Output (+0.5H)

Output Phase Variable Range

H Phase (0.5H to +0.5H) + V Phase (100 lines)

Approx. 0.3H

+0.5H

Internal Fixed DL

Approx. 0.7H to +0.3H

Line Synchronizer Range

H Phase (0.5H to +0.5H) + V Phase (100 lines)

Output Phase Variable Range

Internal Fixed DL

Approx. 0.2H to +0.8H Approx.

0.2H

Line Synchronizer Range

Approx. 0.2H

Line Synchronizer Range: Range for automatic phase adjustment.

111

Input/output signal settings

Input signals

FS: On, Off Mode: Normal, Up Convert or

Dot by Dot (cannot be selected when the system format is 720p)

Video effects

Output signals

1

Delay: 90H (75H) or 1F

2 See Setting the frame synchronizer.

See Setting the down-converter (optional).

Frame synchronizer

Down-converter

Output Phase

Input Non- synchronized

input

Output signal 1 Normal

Output signal 2 Down Converter (90H)

Output signal 2 Down Converter (1F)

System Mode FS Phase Delay

amount Phase

Delay amount

Phase Delay

amount

Sync signal (Reference): Black burst signal (BB), tri-level sync signal (Tri-level sync), internal reference signal (Internal)

1H Normal Off Not possible Reference+1H 1H 1+90H 1H+90H In-phase with 1

1H+1F

Normal On Possible Reference+1H Max. 1F+1H

1+90H Max. 1F+1H +90H

In-phase with 1

Max. 2F+1HUp Convert/

Dot by Dot On (Forced)

Possible

0H (Example 1)

Normal/ Up Convert/ Dot by Dot

On (Forced)

Possible In-phase with Reference

Max. 1F

1+90H Max. 1F+90H

In-phase with 1

Max. 2F

Sync signal (Reference): Black burst signal (BB Advanced)

1H Normal Off Not possible Reference 90H+1H

1H 1+90H 1H+90H In-phase with 1

1F+1H

Normal On Possible Reference 90H+1H

Max. 1F90H +1H

1+90H Max. 1F+1H

In-phase with 1

Max. 2F90H +1H

Up Convert/ Dot by Dot

On (Forced)

Possible

0H (Example 2)

Normal/ Up Convert/ Dot by Dot

On (Forced)

Possible Reference 90H

Max. 1F90H

1+90H (In-phase with Reference)

Max. 1F

In-phase with 1

Max. 2F90H

p For 1080/50i and 720/50p, the 90H indicated above becomes 75H. p Conversion based on the HD format applies for 1H. pWhen DVE effect and PinP effect have been used as the video effects, the output signal is delayed by +1F. pWhen images are output to a multi view display, they are delayed by +1F.

112

Input/output signal settings

(for 1080/59.94i format)

(Example 1)

F1 F2

F1 F2

F1 F2

F1 F2

Input signals (non-synchronized)

1F (frame)

Sync signal (Reference)

Output signal 1

Output signal 2 (90H)

Output signal 2 (1F)

Max. 1F

Max. 2F

Max. 1F+90H

(Example 2)

F1 F2

F1 F2

F1 F2

F1 F2

Input signals (non-synchronized)

1F (frame)

Sync signal (Reference)

Output signal 1

Output signal 2 (90H)

Output signal 2 (1F)

Max. 1F90H

Max. 2F90H

Max. 1F

113

Input/output signal settings

Setting the multi view display

Setting the screen layout

You can select one of the following 10 patterns for the screen layout. The multi view display of this unit supports MV1 and MV2. You can select one of these to display on the built-in display.

4Split 5-aSplit 5-bSplit 6-aSplit 6-bSplit

9Split 10-aSplit 10-bSplit 12Split 16Split

Display of the following signals can be assigned to sub scens 1 to 16.

Signals that can be assigned IN1, IN2, SDI IN3 to 8, IN-A1 to 4, IN-B1 to 4, Black, CBGD1, CBGD2, Still1V, Still1K, Still2V, Still2K, Clip1V, Clip1K, Clip2V, Clip2K, PGM, PVW, CLN, ME PGM, Key Out, MV1, MV2, AUX1 to 4, Clock

1Press the XPT MV button to light its indicator, and display the Multi View Display menu.

2Use [F1] to display the MV Split sub menu.

3Use [F2] to set the split-screen display mode using the Split item.

4Use [F3] to set the size mode for the split screen in the Size item.

Fit The sizes of the split frame and the split screen will be the same.

SQ The sizes of the split frame and the split screen will be smaller, and the material name, level meter, etc., are displayed on the outside of the split screen.

5Use [F1] to display the MV Pattern 1/4 to MV Pattern 4/4 sub menus.

6Use [F2] to [F5] to set the names of the signals to be displayed on the sub screens (1 to 16).

pWhen an input signal (IN1, IN2, SDI IN3 to 8, IN-A1 to 4, IN-B1 to 4) is selected, the display of the material name set in Input menu Name sub menu depends on the characters or symbols used. pWhen AUX buses (AUX1 to 4) are selected as the input signal, the material name displayed inside [ ] depends on the characters and symbols.

pWhen the AUX bus for which MV has been selected is displayed on the sub screen of the multi view display, the images are looped as if two mirrors were facing each other.

p 12 split frames cannot be selected for 720p and 720i.

43

21 21

53 4 21

53 4 21

64 53 21

64 53

4Split 5-aSplit 5-bSplit 6-aSplit 6-bSplit

7 8 9

4 5 6

1 2 3 1

3 4 5 6

7 8 9 10

2

1

3 4 5 6

7 8 9 10

2

21

653 4 7

11108 9 12

1 2 3 4

5 6 7 8

9 10 11 12

13 14 15 16

9Split 10-aSplit 10-bSplit 12Split 16Split

114

Input/output signal settings

Setting the split frame and characters

Set the frame, character brightness and background of the split screens to be displayed on the multi view display.

1Press the XPT MV button to light its indicator, and display

the Multi View Display menu.

2Use [F1] to display the MV Frame sub menu.

3Use [F2] to set the split frame brightness and split frame display using the Frame item.

LUM0%, LUM25%, LUM50%, LUM75%, LUM100%

Select one of these settings for the brightness of the split frame (gray scale).

Off The split frame is not displayed.

4Use [F3] to set the character brightness and character display using the Character item.

LUM0%, LUM25%, LUM50%, LUM75%, LUM100%

Select one of these character (gray scale) brightness settings.

Off The characters are not displayed. Neither is the character background shown.

5Use [F4] to set whether the character background (half-tone) is to be displayed using the Label item.

On The character background is displayed.

Off The character background is not displayed.

p This is enabled when Fit mode is on.

Setting the tally displays

Set the tally displays to be superimposed onto the split frame of the multi view display. You can set 4 tally groups on this unit, and you can set materials for each of the groups. Tally groups 1 and 2 can be displayed on the multi view display.

1Press the CONF SYS button to light its indicator, and display

the System menu.

2Use [F1] to display the Tally MV Color sub menu.

3Use [F2] to [F5] to set the display color for Group1 to 4.

Group1 Fixed to Red.

Group2 to Group4

Select one from Red, Green, Yellow, or Orange.

4Use [F1] to display the Tally Target sub menu.

5Use [F2] to [F5] to select the material to allocate to Group1 to 4.

PGM Program video signal

PVW Preview video signal

CLN Clean signal

ME PGM ME program video signal

KeyOut Key output signal

AUX1 AUX1 bus output signal

AUX2 AUX2 bus output signal

AUX3 AUX3 bus output signal

AUX4 AUX4 bus output signal

6Press the XPT MV button to light its indicator, and display

the Multi View Display menu.

7Use [F1] to display the Tally Group 1 / 2 sub menu.

p Groups 1 and 2 set in 1 to 5 above can be set to display on the multi view display.

115

Input/output signal settings

8Use [F2] to [F4] to set the tally displays to overlay on the split frame of the multi view display.

IN1

Box

Label Left Label Right

On Tally displays are displayed.

Off No tally displays are shown.

Changing the material names

The material names of the input signals (SDI IN1 to SDI IN8, IN-A1, IN-A2, IN-B1, IN-B2) to be set on the multi view display can be changed. These names can be selected from the default settings or user settings.

1Press the IN OUT button to light its indicator, and display

the Input menu.

2Use [F1] to display the Input sub menu.

3Use [F2] to select the input to be set using the Select item. Refer to Input signal settings.

4Use [F1] to display the Name sub menu.

5Use [F2] to select the type of material names using the Type item.

Default (default settings)

The following material names are selected automatically. SDI IN1 to SDI IN8, IN-A1, IN-A2, IN-B1, IN-B2

User (user settings)

The material names are set using up to 32 characters.

User type setting procedure

1On the Name sub menu, use [F2] to select User using the Type item.

2Press [F3] to display the keyboard screen.

3Use [F1] to [F3], the positioner, the rotary encoders, and the number keys to enter a name, then press [F4]. To clear the name which has been input and close the keyboard screen, press [F5]. Refer to Keyboard screen operations.

Setting the level meters

Level meters for the embedded audio signals transferred by the SDI/HDMI input can be displayed on the split screens.

Left display: Channel 1 of group 1 Right display: Channel 2 of group 1

1Press the XPT DSBL button to light its indicator, and display

the Multi View Display menu.

2Use [F1] to display the Display sub menu.

3Use [F2] to set the level meter display using the Level Meter item.

On The level meters are displayed.

Off The level meters are not displayed.

116

Input/output signal settings

Setting the input signal marks

The status of the input signals can be displayed in front of the material names displayed on the split screens.

F mark: This appears when the input signals are frozen. ! mark: This appears when no signals are input or when signals

with different formats are input.

pWhen the F mark is displayed, the ! mark is not displayed.

1On the Display sub menu, use [F3] to set the input signal status display using the Input Status item.

On The input signal status is displayed.

Off The input signal status is not displayed.

Setting the markers

Safety markers can be displayed for the multi view materials.

1On the Display sub menu, use [F4] to set the marker display using the Marker item.

4:3 The markers are displayed using the 4:3 aspect ratio.

16:9 The markers are displayed using the 16:9 aspect ratio.

Off The markers are not displayed.

2Use [F5] to set the size of the markers using the Marker Size item.

117

Input/output signal settings

Ancillary settings for the AUX bus, PGM, and PVW

Set the function that passes through the V ancillary data and embedded audio data of the SDI/HDMI input signal.

pp When the system format of this unit is set to 2160/59.94p, 2160/50p, 1080/59.94i, 720/59.94p, 1080/50i, or 720/50p, even when the SD format signal (480/59.94i or 576/50i) is input in Up Convert mode, the ancillary data and embedded audio data can still be passed through.

1Press the CONF SYS button to light its indicator, and display

the System menu.

2Use [F1] to display the Ancillary sub menu.

Setting for the output signals of the AUX buses (AUX1 to AUX4)

3Use [F2] to select ON or OFF using the AUX item.

OFF The ancillary data and embedded audio of the AUX bus (AUX1 to 4) outputs are not passed through.

ON The ancillary data and embedded audio of the AUX bus (AUX1 to 4) outputs are passed through.

Setting for the program output signals

4Use [F3] to select ON or OFF using the PGM item.

OFF The ancillary data and embedded audio of the PGM outputs are not passed through.

ON The ancillary data and embedded audio of the PGM outputs are passed through.

Setting for the preview output signals

5Use [F4] to select ON or OFF using the PVW item.

OFF The ancillary data and embedded audio of the PVW outputs are not passed through.

ON The ancillary data and embedded audio of the PVW outputs are passed through.

Setting for the output signals of the multi view display

6Use [F5] to select PGM, PVW or OFF using the MV item.

PGM The ancillary data and embedded audio of the PGM are passed through to all MV outputs.

PVW The ancillary data and embedded audio of the PVW are passed through to all MV outputs.

OFF The ancillary data and the embedded audio are not passed through any MV outputs.

pp If Key and DSK are combined, the audio from them are also superimposed. pp When the AUX setting is ON, the DSK1 audio

that is superimposed on AUX1 is simultaneously superimposed on AUX1 for output. Similarly, the DSK2 audio that is superimposed on AUX2 is simultaneously superimposed on AUX2 for output. pp VANC data is not passed if the format of the input

signal is different to the system format.

Notes

118

System settings

Setting the system format

One system format (input/output signal) can be selected.

Do not change the format during any of the following operations: ppWhen reading from a memory card or saving to a memory card ppWhen restoring data from video memory or saving data to flash memory ppWhen recording moving images or still images ppWhen moving images are playing

1Press the CONF SYS button to light its indicator, and display

the System menu.

2Use [F1] to display the Format sub menu.

3Use [F2], select the format using the Format item, and press the [F2] to enter the selection.

Switcher mode settings

1From the Format sub menu, use [F3] to select either 2K or 4K in the Switcher item, then press [F3] to confirm the selection.

pWhen the Switcher mode is changed from either 2K to 4K or from 4K to 2K, a dialog is displayed, so press [F1] to restart the unit. The menu values are initialized after restart.

Dynamic range and color range settings

1From the Format sub menu, use [F4] to select the dynamic range and color range of the image signals handled by this unit in the Color Space item, then press [F4] to confirm the selection.

HDR BT.2020 The dynamic range is HDR and color range operates as BT.2020.

HDR BT.709 The dynamic range is HDR and color range operates as BT.709.

SDR BT.709 The dynamic range is SDR and color range operates as BT.709.

119

System settings

Setting the crosspoints

Assigning signals to the crosspoints

External video input signals and internally generated signals can be assigned to crosspoint buttons 1 to 24. When one of the crosspoint buttons 1 to 24 is held down, the status of the signal assigned is displayed on the built-in display while the button is held down.

Changing the current assignment of the signals selected by the crosspoint buttons will cause the positions of the lit crosspoint buttons to change to correspond with the assignment change. The images output at this time will remain unchanged.

The table below lists the materials which can be assigned.

Signal What appears on the

display Description

IN1, IN2 IN1, IN2 SDI/HDMI input 1, 2

SDI IN3 to SDI IN8 SDI IN3 to SDI IN8 SDI input 3 to 8

IN-A1 to 4, IN-B1 to 4

IN-A1 to 4, IN-B1 to 4

Option slot (SDI, HDMI)

Black BLK Internally generated signal (black)

CBGD1, CBGD2 CBGD1, CBGD2 Internally generated signal (color background)

CBAR CBAR Internally generated signal (color bar)

Still1V, Still1K, Still2V, Still2K

Still1V, Still1K, Still2V, Still2K

Still image video memory

Clip1V, Clip1K, Clip2V, Clip2K

Clip1V, Clip1K, Clip2V, Clip2K

Moving image video memory

CLN CLN CLN (AUX bus and built-in display images only)

KeyOut KeyOut KeyOut (AUX bus and built-in display images only)

ME PGM ME PGM ME PGM (AUX bus and built-in display images only)

Shift SHIFT SHIFT function

None None No assignment

p The image will not be changed by pressing any button to which None is assigned.

The table below lists the default settings.

Button What appears on

the display Button

What appears on the display

Button What appears on

the display

XPT1 IN1 XPT9 CBAR XPT17 None

XPT2 IN2 XPT10 CBGD1 XPT18 None

XPT3 SDI IN 3 XPT11 CBGD2 XPT19 None

XPT4 SDI IN 4 XPT12 None XPT20 None

XPT5 SDI IN 5 XPT13 None XPT21 None

XPT6 SDI IN 6 XPT14 None XPT22 None

XPT7 SDI IN 7 XPT15 None XPT23 None

XPT8 SDI IN 8 XPT16 None XPT24 None

120

System settings Setting the crosspoint switching

The timing at which the crosspoints are to be switched can be set. This switching involves the operations of the crosspoint buttons and [Cut] button.

1Press the XPT MV button to light its indicator, and display

the XPT menu.

2Use [F1] to display the XPT Switch sub menu.

3Use [F2], and select the switching timing using the Timing item.

Any The crosspoints are switched in the nearest field. This is suited to live applications.

Field1 The crosspoints are switched in field 1. This is suited to editing applications.

Field2 The crosspoints are switched in field 2. This is suited to editing applications.

121

System settings

Button assignments

Setting the user buttons

The user can assign several functions which can be set using the menu items into eight user buttons (U1 to U8). The user buttons light in amber when the assigned function is ON and are off when the assigned function is OFF. Each time the user button is pressed, the function setting alternates between ON and OFF.

The table below lists the functions which can be assigned to the user buttons (U1 to U8).

Function name Description of function

KEY1 PVW Output the KEY1 image to the preview output.

KEY2 PVW Output the KEY2 image to the preview output.

KEY3 PVW Output the KEY3 image to the preview output.

DSK1 PVW Output the DSK1 image to the preview output.

DSK2 PVW Output the DSK2 image to the preview output.

GPII-EN Enables or disables GPI-In.

GPIO-EN Enables or disables GPI-Out.

SHIFT Switches all the A/B bus and AUX bus crosspoints between front and rear.

AUX TRANS Enables or disables the AUX bus transitions.

AUX1 TRANS Enables or disables the AUX1 bus transitions.

AUX2 TRANS Enables or disables the AUX2 bus transitions.

DSK1 on AUX1 Adds DSK to the AUX1 output.

DSK2 on AUX2 Adds DSK to the AUX2 output.

Effect Dissolve Switches effect dissolve between ON and OFF.

Dissolve Nothing is assigned.

w Default settings

Button Function name Button Function name

U1 KEY1 PVW U5 DSK2 PVW

U2 KEY2 PVW U6 AUX Trans

U3 KEY3 PVW U7 Effect Dissolve

U4 DSK1 PVW U8 SHIFT

1Press the CONF SYS button to light its indicator, and display

the Config menu.

2Use [F1] to display the User Button1 sub menu and User Button2 sub menu.

p User Button1 to 4 sub menu

3Use [F2] to select the function to be assigned to the [U1] button using the User1 item.

4Use [F3] to select the function to be assigned to the [U2] button using the User2 item.

5Use [F4] to select the function to be assigned to the [U3] button using the User3 item.

6Use [F5] to select the function to be assigned to the [U4] button using the User4 item.

p User Button5 to 8 sub menu

7Use [F2] to select the function to be assigned to the [U5] button using the User5 item.

8Use [F3] to select the function to be assigned to the [U6] button using the User6 item.

9Use [F4] to select the function to be assigned to the [U7] button using the User7 item.

Use [F5] to select the function to be assigned to the [U8] button using the User8 item.

122

System settings

Setting the date and time

The user can set the date and time to be used as the memory cards time stamp. Be absolutely sure to set them when an memory card is to be used.

Setting the date

1Press the CONF SYS button to light its indicator, and display

the System menu.

2Use [F1] to display the Date sub menu.

3Use [F2] to set the year using the Year item.

4Use [F3] to set the month using the Month item.

5Use [F4] to set the day using the Date item.

6Press the [F5] to enter the year/month/day.

Setting the time

1On the System menu, use [F1] to display the Time sub menu.

2Use [F2] to set the hour using the Hour item.

3Use [F3] to set the minutes using the Minute item.

4Use [F4] to set the seconds using the Second item.

5Press the [F5] to enter the hour/minutes/seconds.

Network settings

Proceed with the network settings to perform such tasks as updating the software version via LAN. The network initial setup is: IP address: 192.168.0.8, subnet mask: 255.255.255.0. When using the host computer with settings matching the initial setup, it is not necessary to setup via the menu.

For the setting to take effect, the system must be rebooted. Turn the systems power off and then back on.

Entering the IP address

1Press the CONF SYS button to light its indicator, and display

the System menu.

2Use [F1] to display the Network1 sub menu.

3Use [F2] to [F5] to input the IP address, and press the [F5] (Save) to enter the address.

Entering the subnet mask

1On the System menu, use [F1] to display the Network2 sub menu.

2Use [F2] to [F5] to input the subnet mask, and press the [F5] (Save) to enter the mask.

Setting the gateway

1On the System menu, use [F1] to display the Network3 sub menu.

2Use [F2] to [F5] to set the gateway, and then press [F5] (Save) to enter the setting.

p This will be blank if it is not set.

Display the MAC address

1On the System menu, use [F1] to display the Network4 sub menu. The MAC address now appears.

123

System settings

Setting the built-in display backlight and button illumination

Setting the built-in display backlight

The built-in display backlight can be set to ON or OFF. It is also possible to automatically turn off the built-in display backlight when no control panel operation is performed within a set time interval.

1Press the CONF SYS button to light its indicator, and display

the Config menu.

2Use [F1] to display the LCD Backlight sub menu.

3Use [F2] to select the setting for the backlight using the Light item.

On Backlight is turned on all the time.

Off The backlight turns off as soon as Off is selected as the setting. It lights up when the control panel is operated. (The On status is selected as the setting.)

60, 120, 180 When no control panel operation is performed within a set time interval (60 minutes, 120 minutes, 180 minutes), the built-in display backlight is turned off automatically. Even when the set time interval elapses and the display backlight is turned off, the backlight comes back on when a control panel operation is performed.

4Use [F3] to set the brightness of the backlight using the Adjust item.

Setting the button illumination

The button indicators in the areas listed below can be kept illuminated all the time. It is then easier to read the characters displayed on the buttons even when the unit is operated in dark places.

p Memory/wipe pattern/number key area p User button area p Display area p Crosspoint area p Transition area

1Press the CONF SYS button to light its indicator, and display

the Config menu.

2Use [F1] to display the Button Illumination sub menu.

3Use [F2] to make settings for the memory/wipe pattern/ number key area, the user button area, and the display area in the Dimmer item.

Off The button illumination does not light.

80% to 150% The button illumination lights. Brightness can be adjusted between 80% and 150%.

4Use [F3] to make settings for the button selected in the Lighting item.

80% to 150% The button illumination lights. Brightness can be adjusted between 80% and 150%.

5Use [F4] to make settings for the button when off in the XPT Color item.

Input Make the button illumination light white.

Color Group1 to 8

8 different colors can be set.

6Use [F5] to make settings for the button when off in the Transition Color item.

Input Make the button illumination light white.

Color Group1 to 8

8 different colors can be set.

7Use [F1] to display the Button Color Group1 sub menu.

8Use [F2] to [F4] to set the [R], [G], and [B] for button illumination.

124

System settings

Status displays

Alarm status displays

The alert status (alarms) for this units power supply and cooling fan are displayed on the built-in display.

1Press the CONF SYS button to light its indicator, and display the System menu.

2Use [F1] to display the Alarm sub menu.

The alert status of the power supplies is displayed in the Power item. The alert status of the cooling fan is displayed in the Fan item. The alert status of the internal temperature is displayed in the Temperature item.

No Alarm No irregularity

Alarm Irregularity

Alarm message

A message is displayed on the built-in display when an alarm has occurred.

Alarm message displayed Type of trouble Operation

ALARM ! Fan Stop Shutdown of the cooling fan When OK is pressed, the alarm message is cleared. p Contact your dealer immediately.

ALARM ! Power Failure Drop in the supply voltage

ALARM ! Temperature Rise in the temperature inside the unit

125

System settings Displaying information about the version and optional units

Display information about the versions of software and hardware in the unit and the versions of the optional units that are connected.

Displaying the version information

1Press the CONF SYS button to light its indicator, and display

the System menu.

2Use [F1] to display the System Version sub menu.

p The units system version information is displayed in the System Version item.

Displaying information for optional units

3Use [F1] to display the Option sub menu.

4Use [F2] to select the option slot using the Select item.

SLOT A Option slot A

SLOT B Option slot B

5The types of the optional units connected are displayed in the Slot A/Slot B item.

p None is displayed when there is no connection.

126

System settings

Initialization

Initializing setting data

Initialization returns the set data to the factory shipment status. When settings data is initialized, video memory that has been saved to flash memory is lost.

p The items of the System menu listed below: Network1, Network2, Network3, Date, Time

1Press the CONF SYS button to light its indicator and display

the System menu.

2Use [F1] to display the Initial sub menu.

3Press [F2] to proceed with the initializing.

p Once initialization has been completed the power of the unit shuts off and turns back on again automatically.

Initializing fader

The range for executing a transition can be initialized by operating the fader lever. Initialization should be performed when transitions are not completed to the end even when the fader lever has been moved as far as it will go.

1Press [F3] in the Initial sub menu to perform initialization.

2When initializing, use [F1] to select Yes and press the [F1]. When not initializing, use [F5] to select No and press the [F5].

127

Remote camera link functions

It is possible to connect a maximum of 18 remote cameras to this unit via LAN and remote control them. The remote cameras that can be connected are as follows (as of February 2020):

pp AW-UE150 series pp AW-HR140 series pp AW-HE130 series

pp AW-HN130 series pp AW-UE70 series pp AW-UN70 series

pp AW-HE40 series pp AW-HN40 series pp AW-HE42 series

pw Examples of connections

SDI/HDMI video signals

Switching hub

LAN cables

Live Switcher AV-UHS500

Monitor 1

Monitor 2

Monitor Monitor

LAN cables

Remote camera controller

External DC power supply

External DC power supply

LAN connector

Remote camera (maximum 18)

pp Use a GbE compatible switching hub and Cat5e or better STP LAN cables for the connection between the unit and the remote cameras. pp Furthermore, use a network design so that the IP addresses for the unit and the remote cameras are within the same subnet. pp There is a planned firmware update that will enable support for mutual connection with AW-RP series remote camera controllers.

128

Remote camera link functions

The control functions for the remote cameras connected to this unit are as follows: pp IP address automatic detection pp A maximum of 100 preset memories can be played back and registered pp Pan and tilt of each connected remote camera can be controlled with the positioner on this unit pp Zoom of each connected remote camera can be controlled with the encoders on this unit pp Focus and iris of each connected remote camera can be controlled with the encoders on this unit pp Control of pan, tilt, zoom, focus, and iris can be individually disabled pp Images of remote cameras connected to this unit can be adjusted White balance/AWB/ABB/Gain/R Gain/B Gain/Pedestal pp On-screen menus of remote cameras connected to this unit can be displayed and operated pp The remote cameras connected to this unit can be switched between ON and standby as a group or individually pp It is possible to tally control connected remote cameras linked to the tally status of this unit pp Errors on remote cameras connected to this unit can be detected

Settings for connections to remote cameras

Selecting the terminals for remote camera connection

1Press the IN OUT button to light its indicator and display

the Input menu.

2Use [F1] to display the Input sub menu.

3Press [F2] and select the input signal to which the remote camera is connected in the Select item.

p The following remote camera settings are possible according to the input to IN1 and 2, SDI IN 3 to 8, IN-A1 to 4, and IN-B1 to 4.

IP address settings

To set automatically

You can scan for the IP addresses set in the connected remote cameras and set them in this unit.

1Use [F1] to display the Camera Settings1 sub menu.

2Use [F5] to execute the Scan IP address item to scan for the IP addresses of connected remote cameras.

p The scan results are displayed in the list of the IP address item. pWhen Select From List is displayed, use [F2] and select the IP address of the connected remote camera in the IP address item.

p If the IP address of the remote camera is duplicated, Not Detected is displayed. p Modify the IP address of the unit or the remote camera and set so that there is no duplication.

129

Remote camera link functions

To set manually

You can directly set the IP addresses set in the connected remote cameras in this unit.

1Use [F1] to display the Camera Settings1 sub menu.

2Use [F4] to execute the Edit IP address item, then enter the IP addresses of connected remote cameras.

Remote camera port settings

3From the Camera Settings1 sub menu, use [F3] to set the port to which the remote camera is connected in the Port item.

Remote camera authentication settings

1Use [F1] to display the Camera Settings2 sub menu.

2Use [F2] to execute the Edit User Name item and set the user name used for authentication with the remote camera.

3Use [F3] to execute the Edit Password item, then set the password used for authentication with the remote camera.

Checking the remote camera connection status

1Use [F1] to display the Camera Settings2 sub menu.

2The camera name set on the remote camera is displayed in the Name item.

3The IP connection status of the unit and the remote cameras is displayed in the Network Status item.

No IP Address

The IP address of the camera has not been entered in the Input menu.

Now Checking

The unit and the remote camera are communicating.

Connected The unit and the remote camera are connected.

Unauthorized Authentication information has not been entered or is incorrect.

Not Connected

There is a communication error.

130

Remote camera link functions

Remote camera operation direction settings

You can use the positioner and encoders of this unit to control the pan, tilt, zoom, focus, and iris of remote cameras connected to this unit. The settings for the operation direction are made as follows:

1Use [F1] to display the Camera Settings3 sub menu.

2The pan control direction for the remote camera using the positioner of this unit is set in the Pan Direction item.

Normal The operation direction of the positioner and the direction of image movement are the same.

Reverse The operation direction of the positioner and the direction of image movement are the opposite.

3The tilt control direction for the remote camera using the positioner of this unit is set in the Tilt Direction item.

Normal The operation direction of the positioner and the direction of image movement are the same.

Reverse The operation direction of the positioner and the direction of image movement are the opposite.

4Use [F1] to display the Camera Settings4 sub menu.

5The zoom control direction for the remote camera using [F1]/[F2]/[F3]/[Z] operations of this unit is set in the Zoom Direction item.

Normal Zoom moves to the telephoto end when [F1] is pressed. Zoom moves to the wide end when [F2] is pressed. Zoom moves to the telephoto end when [F3] is pressed/[Z] is turned clockwise. Zoom moves to the wide end when [F3] is pressed/[Z] is turned counterclockwise.

Reverse Zoom moves to the wide end when [F1] is pressed. Zoom moves to the telephoto end when [F2] is pressed. Zoom moves to the wide end when [F3] is pressed/[Z] is turned clockwise. Zoom moves to the telephoto end when [F3] is pressed/[Z] is turned counterclockwise.

6The focus control direction for the remote camera using [F4] operations of this unit is set in the Focus Direction item.

Normal Focus moves to the far side with a clockwise turn. Focus moves to the near side with a counterclockwise turn.

Reverse Focus moves to the near side with a clockwise turn. Focus moves to the far side with a counterclockwise turn.

7The iris control direction for the remote camera using [F5] operations of this unit is set in the Iris Direction item.

Normal The iris opens with a clockwise turn. The iris closes with a counterclockwise turn.

Reverse The iris closes with a clockwise turn. The iris opens with a counterclockwise turn.

Remote camera tally control settings

You can link the red tally control of remote cameras connected to this unit to the red tally control of this unit.

1Use [F1] to display the Camera Settings3 sub menu.

2Set the link between the red tally control on this unit and the red tally control on the remote camera in the Tally (Group1) item.

Enable Linked.

Disable Not linked.

131

Remote camera link functions

Selecting the cameras to be operated

By connecting remote cameras to this unit, you can control remote cameras using the positioner and encoders of this unit.

1Assign the remote cameras connected to XPT. Refer to Selecting the terminals for remote camera connection for information on how to assign.

2Press the [DISP/CAM] button to make it turn green.

KEY1 F/S

KEY2 F/S

KEY3 F/S

DSK1 F/S

DSK2 F/S

MV1 MV2

PGM PVW

DISP CAM

AUX BUS DELEGATION AUX /DISP SOURCEAMBER : FILL / GREEN : SOURCE

AUX1

AUX

AUX2 AUX3 AUX4

SHIFT

XPT2

3Select the remote cameras assigned in Step 1 as the CAM bus sources.

p The selected buses turn green.

The inputs that can be selected as the CAM bus sources are the following inputs. XPTs other than these cannot be selected.

IN1 to IN2 SDI IN1 to SDI IN8 IN-A1 to IN-A4 IN-B1 to IN-B4

pWhen remote camera control is enabled, the [CAM CONT] button blinks orange.

Camera control is disabled if the menus displayed are as follows when the [MENU] button is pressed:

Background menu Key1 to Key3 menu DSK1 menu Chroma Key menu While the keyboard screen is being displayed

4The pan and tilt on the remote camera connected to this unit are controlled by moving the positioner up, down, left, and right.

VMEM

BKGD PATT

CAM CONT

KEY PATT

MENU HOLD

PRJ SD Card

ALARM LINK

Z ZOOM

X/Y PAN/TLT

Blinks

5Turning [Z] left and right adjusts the control speed for pan/tilt and operates the zoom.

You can switch the control speed and zoom operation by pressing [Z].

132

Remote camera link functions

Controlling in the camera control screen

When remote cameras are connected to this unit, you can control them in the camera control screen while displaying the input images from the selected camera on the built-in LCD.

1While the unit is connected to the remote camera, press the CAM CONT button that is blinking orange.

2The display on the built-in LCD of the unit switches.

F1 F2 F3 F4 F5

A Input source information display

The following information is displayed: The CAM bus source material name/camera name/(camera model name)/camera status The name set on the remote camera is displayed as the camera name.

Camera status

Power On Normal situation

Pan & Tilt Alarm When a problem is detected with the pan/tilt of the camera

Fan Alarm When a problem is detected with the fan of the camera

Other Alarm When a problem is detected with something other than the pan/tilt or fan of the camera

B Z-Dial Indicates the application for [Z]. Each time you press [Z], operation switches between P-T Speed and Zoom.

P-T Speed Indicates the status of the control speed of pan/tilt. Fast indicates fast operation and Slow indicates slow operation.

Zoom Indicates the zoom position. Tele indicates the telephoto side and Wide indicates the wide side.

Focus Indicates the focus position. Far indicates the far side and Near indicates the near side. Auto is displayed when auto focus is on.

Iris Indicates the iris status. Open indicates that the iris is open and Close indicates that the iris is closed. Auto is displayed when the auto iris is on.

C [F1] Zoom moves to the telephoto end at a constant speed when the button is pressed. An explanation is also displayed on the Menu screen.

D [F2] Zoom moves to the wide end at a constant speed when the button is pressed. An explanation is also displayed on the Menu screen.

E [F3] Turn left and right to operate the zoom. Zoom to the wide end with a counterclockwise turn and to the telephoto end with a clockwise turn. An explanation is also displayed on the Menu screen.

F [F4] Turn left and right to operate the focus. Focus moves to the near side with a counterclockwise turn and to the far side with a clockwise turn. Focus switches between auto and manual when the button is pressed. An explanation is also displayed on the Menu screen.

G [F5] Turn left and right to operate the iris. The iris closes with a counterclockwise turn and the iris opens with a clockwise turn. Iris switches between auto and manual when the button is pressed. An explanation is also displayed on the Menu screen.

p If control of the remote cameras is disabled, explanations for F1 to F5 are not displayed.

133

Remote camera link functions

Remote camera settings

When the unit is connected to the remote camera, you can make settings on the camera from this unit.

Selecting the remote camera, checking information, and controlling power

1Press the CAM CONT button to light its indicator and display the Camera menu.

2Use [F1] to display the Camera Information sub menu.

3Use [F2] to select the input source of the remote camera you want to set in Input Selection.

You can check the following information. Name The name of the remote camera connected to the unit is displayed. The name set on the remote camera is displayed.

Model The model names of the remote cameras connected to the unit are displayed.

Status The IP connection status of the unit and the remote cameras is displayed.

No IP Address The IP address of the camera has not been entered in the Input menu

Now Checking The unit and the remote camera are communicating and are not yet finished

Connected The unit and the remote camera are communicating normally

Unauthorized Authentication information for the unit and the remote camera has not been entered or is incorrect

Not Connected There is a communication error between the unit and the remote camera

Please Wait Remote camera currently switching between power ON and standby

Pan & Tilt Alarm A problem has been detected with the pan/tilt of the remote camera

Fan Alarm A problem has been detected with the fan of the remote camera

Other Alarm A problem has been detected with something other than the pan/tilt or fan of the remote camera

4Use [F1] to display the Camera Control sub menu.

5Use [F2] and switch between power ON and standby for the remote camera corresponding to the input signal selected in the Power item.

6Use [F3] to turn ON all of the remote cameras connected to this unit in the All Power On item.

7Use [F4] to set to standby all of the remote cameras connected to this unit in the All Standby item.

8Use [F5] to switch the use for [Z] in the Z-Dial Usage item.

P-T Sp. & Zoom Either adjust the control speed for pan/tilt or set the zoom control. Press and you can switch the control speed and zoom control.

P-T Speed Only Set only the pan/tilt control speed adjustments.

134

Remote camera link functions

Remote camera control speed settings

You can set the pan/tilt control, zoom control speed, focus control speed, and iris control speed for remote cameras connected to this unit. The adjustments can be made in 32 steps, with the control speed increasing the higher the number.

1Press the CAM CONT button to light its indicator and display

the Camera menu.

2Use [F1] to display the Control Speed sub menu.

3Use [F2] to set the pan/tilt control speed in the Pan & Tilt item.

4Use [F3] to set the zoom control speed in the Zoom item.

5Use [F4] to set the focus control speed in the Focus item.

6Use [F5] to set the iris control speed in the Iris item.

Remote camera on-screen menu and color bar settings

1Press the CAM CONT button to light its indicator and display

the Camera menu.

2Use [F1] to display the OSD Menu & Color Bars sub menu.

3Use [F2] to set the display of the on-screen menu of the remote camera in the OSD Menu item.

On Displayed.

Off Not displayed.

4You can use [F3] to operate the on-screen menus of the remote camera in the Menu Operation item.

Counterclockwise turn

Moves the cursor up.

Clockwise turn Moves the cursor down.

Press Confirmed.

5Use [F4] to set the output images from the remote camera in the color bar in the Color Bars item.

On The color bar is set. Set the type of color bar on the camera.

Off Normal image is set.

135

Remote camera link functions

Remote camera lens control settings

1Press the CAM CONT button to light its indicator and display

the Camera menu.

2Use [F1] to display the Lens Control sub menu.

3Use [F2] to set the auto focus of the remote camera in the Auto Focus item.

On Auto Focus

Off Manual Focus

4Use [F3] to set the auto iris of the remote camera in the Auto Iris item.

On Auto Iris

Off Manual Iris

p The operation explanation on the camera control screen is as follows.

When Auto Focus/Auto Iris is Off:

When Auto Focus/Auto Iris is On:

Remote camera image adjustment settings

1Press the CAM CONT button to light its indicator and display

the Camera menu.

2Use [F1] to display the AWB sub menu.

3Use [F4] to set the automatic white balance adjustment mode in the AWB Mode item.

4Use [F2] to execute the automatic white balance adjustments.

5The result of the adjustment is displayed in the Last AWB Result item.

Successful Successful.

Fail Failed.

When this unit is starting up or the input signal has been changed

6Use [F1] to display the ABB sub menu.

7Use [F2] to execute the automatic black balance adjustments.

8The result of the adjustment is displayed in the Last ABB Result item.

Successful Successful.

Fail Failed.

When this unit is starting up or the input signal has been changed

9Use [F1] to display the Gain1/Gain2/Pedestal sub menus.

Use [F2] to [F5] to set each of the items.

p Refer to the operating instructions for the connected remote camera for details about the setting values.

136

Remote camera link functions

Remote camera preset memory playback settings

1Press the CAM CONT button to light its indicator and display

the Camera menu.

2Use [F1] to display the Preset Settings sub menu.

3Use [F2] to [F5] to set each of the items.

p Refer to the operating instructions for the connected remote camera for details about the setting values.

Disabling remote camera control

You can individually disable the control of the pan/tilt, zoom, focus, and iris for remote cameras connected to this unit.

1Press the CAM CONT button to light its indicator and display

the Camera menu.

2Use [F1] to display the Lock sub menu.

3Use [F2] to set the pan/tilt control and speed adjustment control enable/disable of the remote camera in the Pan & Tilt Lock item.

On Disable

Off Enable

pWhen Lock is engaged and you press either the CAM PMEM

button or the CAM CONT button, is displayed above

P-T Speed at the right of the built-in display.

4Use [F3] to set the zoom control and speed adjustment control enable/disable of the remote camera in the Zoom Lock item.

On Disable

Off Enable

pWhen Lock is engaged and you press either the CAM PMEM

button or the CAM CONT button, is displayed above

Zoom at the right of the built-in display. p The [F1]/[F2] operation descriptions will be blank. p ZOOM LOCKED is displayed in the [F3] operation description.

5Use [F4] to set the focus control and speed adjustment control enable/disable of the remote camera in the Focus Lock item.

On Disable

Off Enable

pWhen Lock is engaged and you press either the CAM PMEM

button or the CAM CONT button, is displayed above

Focus at the right of the built-in display. p FOCUS LOCKED is displayed in the [F4] operation description.

6Use [F5] to set the iris control and speed adjustment control enable/disable of the remote camera in the Iris Lock item.

On Disable

Off Enable

pWhen Lock is engaged and you press either the CAM PMEM

button or the CAM CONT button, is displayed above

Iris at the right of the built-in display. p IRIS LOCKED is displayed in the [F5] operation description.

137

Remote camera link functions

Controlling in the camera preset memory screen

When remote cameras are connected to this unit, you can control them in the camera preset screen while displaying the thumbnail image of the selected camera preset memory on the built-in LCD.

1While the unit is connected to the remote camera and the [CAM CONT] button is blinking orange, press the CAM PMEM button.

2The display on the built-in LCD of the unit switches.

p It is possible to save, play back, and delete preset memories using the number keys. p Zoom control is possible using [F1] to [F3]. p It is possible to change the preset scope/preset speed using [F4]/[F5].

You can store up to a maximum of 100 preset memories in the remote cameras connected to this unit. pp They are not stored in this unit.

100 preset memories are divided between 10 pages, so 10 preset memories can be saved in 1 page. If there is a preset memory that corresponds to the number key, the LED of the number key lights. The number key that corresponds to the preset memory that was recalled last on this unit turns orange and all others turn green.

You can select the operation for the preset memory each time you press the [STORE]/[RECALL]/[DEL] buttons. ppWhile the [STORE] button is lit red, you can store preset memories by holding down the number keys. ppWhile the [RECALL] button is lit orange, you can execute preset memories by pressing the number keys. ppWhile the [DEL] button is lit red, you can delete preset memories by holding down the number keys.

STORE

DELMACRO

EDIT

SHOT MEM

KEY1 F/S

KEY2 F/S

KEY3 F/S

DSK1 F/S

DSK2 F/S

MV1 MV2

PGM PVW

DISP CAM

XPT DSBL

TAKE ENTER

7 NEW

8 COPY

9 PASTE

4 INS

5 DEL

6 MOD

1 <

2 >

3 REV

0/10 <<

. >>

C UNDO

CAM PMEM

EVENT MEM

-/+ PAGE

RE CALL

MENU

MEMORY / WIPE PATTERN / 10 KEY

AUX BUS DELEGATION AUX /DISP SOURCEAMBER : FILL / GREEN : SOURCE

STILL 1 STILL 2 TRIM IN REC

CLIP 1 CLIP 2 TRIM OUT

<

F1 F2 F3

AUX1

AUX

AUX2 AUX3 AUX4 MACRO

BKGD KEYSHIFT

MIX MIX

F4 F5

> REV

<< >> TRIM OFF PLAY

STOP

DISPLAY

pp Changing the preset scope/preset speed

pp PMEM operation selection pp Execute operations corresponding to PMEM

pp Switching of the camera that is the target of operation by the CAM bus

pp Zoom control

138

Remote camera link functions

F1 F2 F3 F4 F5

A Input source information display

The following information is displayed. The CAM bus source material name/camera name/(camera model name)/camera status The name set on the remote camera is displayed as the camera name.

Camera status

Power On Normal situation

Pan & Tilt Alarm When a problem is detected with the pan/tilt of the camera

Fan Alarm When a problem is detected with the fan of the camera

Other Alarm When a problem is detected with something other than the pan/tilt or fan of the camera

B Z-Dial Indicates the application for [Z]. Each time you press [Z], operation switches between P-T Speed and Zoom.

P-T Speed Indicates the status of the control speed of pan/tilt. Fast indicates fast operation and Slow indicates slow operation.

Zoom Indicates the zoom position. Tele indicates the telephoto side and Wide indicates the wide side.

Focus Indicates the focus position. Far indicates the far side and Near indicates the near side. Auto is displayed when auto focus is on.

Iris Indicates the iris status. Open indicates that the iris is open and Close indicates that the iris is closed. Auto is displayed when the auto iris is on.

C [F1] Zoom moves to the telephoto end at a constant speed when the button is pressed. An explanation is also displayed on the Menu screen.

D [F2] Zoom moves to the wide end at a constant speed when the button is pressed. An explanation is also displayed on the Menu screen.

E [F3] Turn left and right to operate the zoom. Zoom to the wide end with a counterclockwise turn and to the telephoto end with a clockwise turn. An explanation is also displayed on the Menu screen.

F [F4] Turn left and right to operate the preset targets. Preset targets can be switched between the following 3 modes.

Mode A Set the pan/tilt, zoom, focus, iris, gain, and white balance that are the targets of presetting.

Mode B Set the pan/tilt, zoom, focus, and iris that are the targets of presetting.

Mode C Set the pan/tilt, zoom, and focus that are the targets of presetting.

G [F5]

1 Minimum speed

20 Default value

30 Maximum speed

p The screen displays here show the models that support thumbnails (AW-UE150 series). Other models will not display thumbnails, with icons displayed instead.

139

Remote camera link functions

p If control of the remote cameras is disabled, explanations for F4 and F5 are not displayed.

Storing preset memories

1Operate the CAM PMEM button to make it turn orange.

2Operate the [STORE] button to make it turn amber.

3Hold down the number key that corresponds to the preset memory to be stored to store.

p After storing is complete, the corresponding number key turns green.

p Preset memories can be stored in number keys 1 to 10. p If there is already a preset memory that corresponds to the number key, then storing is not possible even if the key is held down.

STORE

DEL VMEMMACRO

EDIT

SHOT MEM

BKGD PATT

XPT DSBL

TAKE ENTER

7 NEW

8 COPY

9 PASTE

4 INS

5 DEL

6 MOD

1 <

2 >

3 REV

0/10 <<

. >>

C UNDO

CAM PMEM

CAM CONT

EVENT MEM

KEY PATT

-/+ PAGE

RE CALL

MEMORY / WIPE PATTERN / 10 KEY

STILL 1 STILL 2 TRIM IN REC

CLIP 1 CLIP 2 TRIM OUT

< > REV

<< >> TRIM OFF PLAY

STOP

Recalling preset memories

1Operate the CAM PMEM button to make it turn orange.

2Operate the [RECALL] button to make it turn orange.

3When a number key 1 to 10 is pressed, the preset memory that corresponds to the number key is executed.

p The number key that corresponds to the preset memory being recalled blinks green. p The [C](UNDO) button blinks orange during recall, then turns off when recalling is finished. pWhen recalling finishes, the number key that corresponds to the preset memory that was recalled last turns orange.

4Recalling can be stopped by pressing the [C](UNDO) button while recalling.

STORE

DEL VMEMMACRO

EDIT

SHOT MEM

BKGD PATT

XPT DSBL

TAKE ENTER

7 NEW

8 COPY

9 PASTE

4 INS

5 DEL

6 MOD

1 <

2 >

3 REV

0/10 <<

. >>

C UNDO

CAM PMEM

CAM CONT

EVENT MEM

KEY PATT

-/+ PAGE

RE CALL

MEMORY / WIPE PATTERN / 10 KEY

STILL 1 STILL 2 TRIM IN REC

CLIP 1 CLIP 2 TRIM OUT

< > REV

<< >> TRIM OFF PLAY

STOP

Deleting preset memories

1Operate the CAM PMEM button to make it turn orange.

2Operate the [DEL] button to make it turn amber.

3When a number key 1 to 10 is held down, the preset memory that corresponds to the number key can be deleted.

pWhen deleting is finished, the number key that corresponds to the preset memory that was deleted turns off.

140

Remote camera link functions

Selecting a page of preset memories

1Operate the CAM PMEM button to make it turn orange.

2Page selection starts when the [PAGE] button is pressed.

p The [PAGE] button turns orange when a page is selected. Number keys 1 to 10 correspond to page numbers 1 to 10.

3Use the number keys 1 to 10 or the [PAGE] button to complete selection of the page.

p If a number key 1 to 10 is pressed, the current page number changes to the value of the pressed number key. pWhen the [PAGE] button is pressed, the current page number is not changed.

4If there is at least one preset memory in the page, the LED of the number key that corresponds to the page lights.

p The number key that corresponds to the current page turns orange and all the other pages light green. p In the example in the figure below, page numbers 1, 5, 6, 7, 8, and 10 each contain at least one preset memory, and page number 1 is the current page.

STORE

DEL VMEMMACRO

EDIT

SHOT MEM

BKGD PATT

XPT DSBL

TAKE ENTER

7 NEW

8 COPY

9 PASTE

4 INS

5 DEL

6 MOD

1 <

2 >

3 REV

0/10 <<

. >>

C UNDO

CAM PMEM

CAM CONT

EVENT MEM

KEY PATT

-/+ PAGE

RE CALL

MEMORY / WIPE PATTERN / 10 KEY

STILL 1 STILL 2 TRIM IN REC

CLIP 1 CLIP 2 TRIM OUT

< > REV

<< >> TRIM OFF PLAY

STOP

p The targets for project file storing and macro recording are as shown in the below table. Storing project files Selections with the STORE/RECALL/DEL buttons,

Preset page numbers for input signals (for each connected camera)

Macro recording targets Storing preset memories, Recalling preset memories, Deleting preset memories, Stopping with the [C](UNDO) button when recalling preset memories, Selections with the [STORE]/[RECALL]/[DEL] buttons when recalling preset memories, Page selections when recalling preset memories

141

External interfaces

Setting the GPI I/O

The user can set the functions that are to be controlled from the GPI ports and set whether to enable the control.

1Press the CONF SYS button to light its indicator, and display

the Config menu.

2Use [F1] to display the GPI-In Setting sub menu (or GPI-Out Setting sub menu).

3Use [F2] to set On or Off for the control to be exercised from the ports using the GPI-In Enable item (or GPI-Out Enable item).

4Use [F3] to set the AUX bus to be used to notify the tally using the AUX Sel item.

5Use [F1] to display GPI-In Port 1/2 sub menu and GPI-In Port 2/2 sub menu (or GPI-Out Port 1/5 sub menu to GPI-Out Port 5/5 sub menu).

6Use [F2] to [F5] to allocate the functions to be assigned to the respective pin numbers. Refer to Control using the GPI Input port and

Output from the GPI Output port.

p Settings for the GPI-In Enable (or GPI-Out Enable) item can be assigned to one of the user buttons. Refer to Setting the user buttons.

142

External interfaces

w Control using the GPI Input port

Assign Item Description of function assigned Control method

AUTO AUTO button in transition area

Operations are performed using contact inputs (30 ms or more).

CUT CUT button in transition area

KEY ON KEY1 to KEY3 button in transition area

DSK ON DSK1, DSK2 button in transition area

FTB FTB button in transition area

BKGD AUTO AUTO button when the background is selected

BKGD CUT CUT button when the background is selected

KEY AUTO AUTO button when the key is selected

KEY CUT CUT button when the key is selected

REC Still1 Still1 recording

REC Still2 Still2 recording

REC Clip1 Clip1 recording start

REC Clip2 Clip2 recording start

STOP Clip1 Clip1 recording stop or playback stop

STOP Clip2 Clip2 recording stop or playback stop

PLAY Clip1 Clip1 playback start

PLAY Clip2 Clip2 playback start

AUX XPT 1 to 24

Crosspoint buttons (1 to 24) used to switch the AUX buses. p Select the AUX buses (AUX1 to AUX4) to be controlled using the

menu.

REDTly DSBL Red tally signal is not output Functions are enabled using contact inputs (or disabled in open status).

GRNTly DSBL Green tally signal is not output

AUXTly DSBL AUX tally signal is not output

No Assign No function assigned

143

External interfaces

w Output from the GPI Output port

Assign Item Description of function assigned Output

CUT Cut transition executed

Low pulses are output (approx. 50 to 60 ms).

KEY ON Key transition start

DSK ON DSK transition start

FTB ON FTB transition start

BKGD CUT Cut transition for the background executed

KEY CUT Cut transition for a key executed

EVENTMEM Event set by event memory executed

AUTO Auto transition execution in progress

A low level is output.

BKGD AUTO Auto transition execution in progress for background

KEY AUTO Auto transition execution in progress for key

KEY Trans Transition execution in progress for key

DSK Trans Transition execution in progress for DSK

FTB Trans Transition execution in progress for FTB

REDTly1 to 13 Red tally for INPUT1 to INPUT13* A low level is output during tally output.GRNTly1 to 13 Green tally for INPUT1 to INPUT13*

AUXTly1 to 13 When INPUT1 to INPUT13* have been selected by the AUX bus p Select the AUX buses (AUX1 to AUX4) whose signals are to be

output using the menu.

A low level is output while the inputs are selected.

No Assign No function assigned

*: The following inputs are used for INPUT1 to INPUT13.

pp INPUT1 to INPUT8: SDI IN1 to SDI IN8 pp INPUT9: DVI IN pp INPUT10, INPUT11: IN A1, IN A2 pp INPUT12, INPUT13: IN B1, IN B2

144

External interfaces

Com

GPI Out ALARM Out

Example of GPI Out and ALARM connections Ensure that the conditions given below are satisfied.

Dielectric strength: Max. DC 24 V Current: Max. 50 mA

AV-UHS500 (Max. voltage: 24 V)

Tally LED (Max. current: 50 mA)

Com

GPI In

+3.3 V

Example of GPI In connections Provide contact inputs.

AV-UHS500

TALLY/GPI 1

12345

12 11 10

678

15 14 13 9

TALLY/GPI 2

12345

12 11 10

678

15 14 13 9

Pin No. Signal name Pin No. Signal name

1 GPI-Out1 1 GPI-Out10

9 GPI-Out9 9 GPI-Out18

2 GPI-Out2 2 GPI-Out11

10 ALARM Out 10 GPI-Out19

3 GPI-Out3 3 GPI-Out12

11 GPI-In1 11 GPI-In5

4 GPI-Out4 4 GPI-Out13

12 GPI-In2 12 GPI-In6

5 GPI-Out5 5 GPI-Out14

13 GPI-In3 13 GPI-In7

6 GPI-Out6 6 GPI-Out15

14 GPI-In4 14 GPI-In8

7 GPI-Out7 7 GPI-Out16

15 GPI-Com 15 GPI-Com

8 GPI-Out8 8 GPI-Out17

LAN

Connect the unit and computer or the unit and an external device*. *: An external device can be controlled from the unit.

pp Use a LAN cable (category 5e or above).

145

External interfaces

Controlling with external panels

With this unit, you can perform the following operations from external panels (*) connected via an IP network: pp Select materials for each bus pp Execute video transitions pp Play back macro memories pp Play back shot memories

*: This unit supports the LBP series from LAWO. Consult LAWO for LBP series settings and operations.

Preparations

Use a LAN cable to connect the external panel to the LAN connector on the back of the unit. It is possible to connect a maximum of 20 external panels. When connecting multiple external panels, connect via a hub.

External panel settings

Check the following settings on this unit, then make the settings on the connected external panels:

pp System menu Network1 sub menu Take the address value set in the IP Address item of this sub menu and set it as the IP address of the device that will be the target of the external panel operations.

pp System menu ExtPanel Info sub menu Take the port number set in the Port No item of this sub menu and set it as the port number of the device that will be the target of the external panel operations.

Also set the subnet mask (Network2 sub menu) and the default gateway (Network3 sub menu) according to the network environment connected.

Settings on this unit when external panels are connected

Receiving port number settings

1Press the CONF SYS button to light its indicator, and display

the System menu.

2Use [F1] to display the ExtPanel Info sub menu.

3Use [F2] to set the receiving port number used by this unit.

Possible setting range 62000 to 65535

Default value 62010

Shot memory playback target settings

Set the playback targets for when shot memories of this unit are played back by operations on the external panels.

1Press the CONF SYS button to light its indicator, and display

the System menu.

2Use [F1] to display the ExtPanelIP SMEMRecall1/2 sub menu.

3Use [F2] to [F4] to set the playback targets for the shot memory.

p ME, DSK, AUX, color background, and crosspoint area can be individually turned ON/OFF.

146

External interfaces

List of bus IDs and source IDs

When operations are performed on external panels, crosspoint setting commands are issued that specify the materials (Source) for the buses (Destination). When this unit receives the crosspoint setting command from the external panel, materials are selected and video transitions are executed according to the bus and material combinations specified in the command. This section describes the IDs (numbers) used by this unit to identify each bus and each material.

IDs can be categorized broadly into the following 2 types:

1) Normal bus IDs and material IDs IDs that specify the buses inside the switcher (ME1PGM, AUX1, etc.) and the switcher materials (SDI IN1, CBGD1, STILL1-V, etc.). Use a number between 1 and 512.

2) Extended bus IDs and extended material IDs IDs used for playback of video transitions, macro memories, and shot memories. When this unit receives a crosspoint setting command in which the same extended ID is specified for the bus and the material, the corresponding function is executed. For example, when a command is received that specifies the ME1 AUTO material (ID: 522) for the ME1 AUTO bus (ID: 522), an AUTO transition is executed at ME1. Use a number between 513 and 1023.

Executable operations Specified bus and material

ME key transition ME1 KEY1 AUTO to ME1 KEY3 AUTO

ME key transition (CUT) ME1 KEY1 CUT to ME1 KEY3 CUT

ME AUTO transition ME1 BKGD AUTO

ME CUT transition ME1 BKGD CUT

DSK transition DSK1 AUTO to DSK2 AUTO

DSK transition (CUT) DSK1 CUT to DSK2 CUT

Playing back macro registered memories MACROPLAY1-1 to MACROPLAY9-9

Playing back shot memory registered memories SHOTPLAY1-1 to SHOTPLAY9-9

pp Consult LAWO for details on how to assign IDs to the operations of each of the buttons on the LBP series.

147

External interfaces

Bus ID ID Bus ID Bus ID Bus ID Bus ID Bus

1 ME1PGM 100 DSK2-S 149 162 MV1-10 176 MV2-8

2 ME1PVW 101 150 VMEM-V 163 MV1-11 177 MV2-9

3 ME1KEY1-F 151 VMEM-K 164 MV1-12 178 MV2-10

4 ME1KEY1-S 112 152 165 MV1-13 179 MV2-11

5 ME1KEY2-F 113 AUX1 166 MV1-14 180 MV2-12

6 ME1KEY2-S 114 AUX2 153 MV1-1 167 MV1-15 181 MV2-13

7 ME1KEY3-F 115 AUX3 154 MV1-2 168 MV1-16 182 MV2-14

8 ME1KEY3-S 116 AUX4 155 MV1-3 169 MV2-1 183 MV2-15

9 117 156 MV1-4 170 MV2-2 184 MV2-16

157 MV1-5 171 MV2-3 185

96 140 158 MV1-6 172 MV2-4 97 DSK1-F 141 DISP 159 MV1-7 173 MV2-5 512

98 DSK1-S 142 160 MV1-8 174 MV2-6

99 DSK2-F 161 MV1-9 175 MV2-7

: Unused ID

Material ID ID Bus ID Bus ID Bus ID Bus ID Bus

1 SDI_IN1 145 CBGD1 158 CLIP1K 171 Key Out 209 ME PGM

2 SDI_IN2 146 CBGD2 159 CLIP2V 172 CLN 210

3 SDI_IN3 147 CBAR 160 CLIP2K 173 4 SDI_IN4 148 BLACK 161 226

5 SDI_IN5 149 STILL1V 200 227 AUX1

6 SDI_IN6 150 STILL1K 164 201 PGM 228 AUX2

7 SDI_IN7 151 STILL2V 165 MV1 202 229 AUX3

8 SDI_IN8 152 STILL2K 166 MV2 203 PVW 230 AUX4

9 153 167 204 231

144 157 CLIP1V 170 208 512

: Unused ID

148

External interfaces

Extended bus ID ID Bus ID Bus ID Bus ID Bus ID Bus

513 633 MACROPLAY3-4 679 MACROPLAY7-10 725 SHOTPLAY2-6 771 SHOTPLAY7-2

514 ME1 KEY1 AUTO 634 MACROPLAY3-5 680 MACROPLAY8-1 726 SHOTPLAY2-7 772 SHOTPLAY7-3

515 ME1 KEY2 AUTO 635 MACROPLAY3-6 681 MACROPLAY8-2 727 SHOTPLAY2-8 773 SHOTPLAY7-4

516 ME1 KEY3 AUTO 636 MACROPLAY3-7 682 MACROPLAY8-3 728 SHOTPLAY2-9 774 SHOTPLAY7-5

517 637 MACROPLAY3-8 683 MACROPLAY8-4 729 SHOTPLAY2-10 775 SHOTPLAY7-6

518 ME1 KEY1 CUT 638 MACROPLAY3-9 684 MACROPLAY8-5 730 SHOTPLAY3-1 776 SHOTPLAY7-7

519 ME1 KEY2 CUT 639 MACROPLAY3-10 685 MACROPLAY8-6 731 SHOTPLAY3-2 777 SHOTPLAY7-8

520 ME1 KEY3 CUT 640 MACROPLAY4-1 686 MACROPLAY8-7 732 SHOTPLAY3-3 778 SHOTPLAY7-9

521 641 MACROPLAY4-2 687 MACROPLAY8-8 733 SHOTPLAY3-4 779 SHOTPLAY7-10

522 ME1 BKGD AUTO 642 MACROPLAY4-3 688 MACROPLAY8-9 734 SHOTPLAY3-5 780 SHOTPLAY8-1

523 ME1 BKGD CUT 643 MACROPLAY4-4 689 MACROPLAY8-10 735 SHOTPLAY3-6 781 SHOTPLAY8-2

524 644 MACROPLAY4-5 690 MACROPLAY9-1 736 SHOTPLAY3-7 782 SHOTPLAY8-3

645 MACROPLAY4-6 691 MACROPLAY9-2 737 SHOTPLAY3-8 783 SHOTPLAY8-4

593 646 MACROPLAY4-7 692 MACROPLAY9-3 738 SHOTPLAY3-9 784 SHOTPLAY8-5

594 DSK1 AUTO 647 MACROPLAY4-8 693 MACROPLAY9-4 739 SHOTPLAY3-10 785 SHOTPLAY8-6

595 DSK2 AUTO 648 MACROPLAY4-9 694 MACROPLAY9-5 740 SHOTPLAY4-1 786 SHOTPLAY8-7

596 649 MACROPLAY4-10 695 MACROPLAY9-6 741 SHOTPLAY4-2 787 SHOTPLAY8-8

597 650 MACROPLAY5-1 696 MACROPLAY9-7 742 SHOTPLAY4-3 788 SHOTPLAY8-9

598 DSK1 CUT 651 MACROPLAY5-2 697 MACROPLAY9-8 743 SHOTPLAY4-4 789 SHOTPLAY8-10

599 DSK2 CUT 652 MACROPLAY5-3 698 MACROPLAY9-9 744 SHOTPLAY4-5 790 SHOTPLAY9-1

600 653 MACROPLAY5-4 699 MACROPLAY9-10 745 SHOTPLAY4-6 791 SHOTPLAY9-2

654 MACROPLAY5-5 700 MACROPLAY10-1 746 SHOTPLAY4-7 792 SHOTPLAY9-3

609 655 MACROPLAY5-6 701 MACROPLAY10-2 747 SHOTPLAY4-8 793 SHOTPLAY9-4

610 MACROPLAY1-1 656 MACROPLAY5-7 702 MACROPLAY10-3 748 SHOTPLAY4-9 794 SHOTPLAY9-5

611 MACROPLAY1-2 657 MACROPLAY5-8 703 MACROPLAY10-4 749 SHOTPLAY4-10 795 SHOTPLAY9-6

612 MACROPLAY1-3 658 MACROPLAY5-9 704 MACROPLAY10-5 750 SHOTPLAY5-1 796 SHOTPLAY9-7

613 MACROPLAY1-4 659 MACROPLAY5-10 705 MACROPLAY10-6 751 SHOTPLAY5-2 797 SHOTPLAY9-8

614 MACROPLAY1-5 660 MACROPLAY6-1 706 MACROPLAY10-7 752 SHOTPLAY5-3 798 SHOTPLAY9-9

615 MACROPLAY1-6 661 MACROPLAY6-2 707 MACROPLAY10-8 753 SHOTPLAY5-4 799 SHOTPLAY9-10

616 MACROPLAY1-7 662 MACROPLAY6-3 708 MACROPLAY10-9 754 SHOTPLAY5-5 800 SHOTPLAY10-1

617 MACROPLAY1-8 663 MACROPLAY6-4 709 MACROPLAY10-10 755 SHOTPLAY5-6 801 SHOTPLAY10-2

618 MACROPLAY1-9 664 MACROPLAY6-5 710 SHOTPLAY1-1 756 SHOTPLAY5-7 802 SHOTPLAY10-3

619 MACROPLAY1-10 665 MACROPLAY6-6 711 SHOTPLAY1-2 757 SHOTPLAY5-8 803 SHOTPLAY10-4

620 MACROPLAY2-1 666 MACROPLAY6-7 712 SHOTPLAY1-3 758 SHOTPLAY5-9 804 SHOTPLAY10-5

621 MACROPLAY2-2 667 MACROPLAY6-8 713 SHOTPLAY1-4 759 SHOTPLAY5-10 805 SHOTPLAY10-6

622 MACROPLAY2-3 668 MACROPLAY6-9 714 SHOTPLAY1-5 760 SHOTPLAY6-1 806 SHOTPLAY10-7

623 MACROPLAY2-4 669 MACROPLAY6-10 715 SHOTPLAY1-6 761 SHOTPLAY6-2 807 SHOTPLAY10-8

624 MACROPLAY2-5 670 MACROPLAY7-1 716 SHOTPLAY1-7 762 SHOTPLAY6-3 808 SHOTPLAY10-9

625 MACROPLAY2-6 671 MACROPLAY7-2 717 SHOTPLAY1-8 763 SHOTPLAY6-4 809 SHOTPLAY10-10

626 MACROPLAY2-7 672 MACROPLAY7-3 718 SHOTPLAY1-9 764 SHOTPLAY6-5 810

627 MACROPLAY2-8 673 MACROPLAY7-4 719 SHOTPLAY1-10 765 SHOTPLAY6-6 628 MACROPLAY2-9 674 MACROPLAY7-5 720 SHOTPLAY2-1 766 SHOTPLAY6-7 1024

629 MACROPLAY2-10 675 MACROPLAY7-6 721 SHOTPLAY2-2 767 SHOTPLAY6-8

630 MACROPLAY3-1 676 MACROPLAY7-7 722 SHOTPLAY2-3 768 SHOTPLAY6-9

631 MACROPLAY3-2 677 MACROPLAY7-8 723 SHOTPLAY2-4 769 SHOTPLAY6-10

632 MACROPLAY3-3 678 MACROPLAY7-9 724 SHOTPLAY2-5 770 SHOTPLAY7-1 : Disabled ID (-1) sent

149

Appearance

Unit: mm (inch)

U1 U2

PICT

STORE

DEL VMEMMACRO

EDIT

U3

MENU MODE

SHOT MEM

KEY1 F/S

PGM A

PST B

KEY2 F/S

KEY3 F/S

DSK1 F/S

DSK2 F/S

MV1 MV2

PGM PVW

FTB ON

KEY1 ON

KEY2 ON

KEY3 ON

DSK1 ON

DSK2 ON

DISP CAM

BKGD PATT

XPT DSBL

TAKE ENTER

7 NEW

8 COPY

9 PASTE

4 INS

5 DEL

6 MOD

1 <

2 >

3 REV

0/10 <<

. >>

C UNDO

CAM PMEM

CAM CONT

EVENT MEM

KEY PATT

-/+ PAGE

RE CALL

MENU OFF

MENU HOLD

WFM VECT

XPT MV

IN OUT

CONF SYS

VMEM MACRO

SHOT EVENT

BKGD CBGD

TIME CAM

PRJ SD Card

KEY1 CKEY

KEY2 KEY3

DSK1 DSK2

U4

USER

MENU

MEMORY / WIPE PATTERN / 10 KEY

AUX BUS DELEGATION AUX /DISP SOURCE

1/13 2/14 3/15 4/16 5/17 6/18 7/19 8/20 9/21 10/22 11/23 12/24

AMBER : FILL / GREEN : SOURCE WIPE DIRECTION

STILL 1 STILL 2 TRIM IN REC

CLIP 1 CLIP 2 TRIM OUT

<

F1 F2 F3

AUX1

AUX

AUX2 AUX3 AUX4 MACRO N/R

BKGD KEY

MIX

CUTSHIFT

SHIFT

SHIFT

AUTO

MIX MIX

WIPE

WIPE WIPE

R

F4 F5

> REV

<< >> TRIM OFF PLAY

STOP

DISPLAY

POWER

ALARM LINK

Z ZOOM

X/Y PAN/TLT

U5 U6 U7 U8

TALLY/GPI 1

EXPANTION SLOT A EXPANTION SLOT B

REF BOOT SV NM

SIGNAL GND

POWER

LAN 12G SDI IN 12G SDI OUTHDMI IN HDMI IOUT 1 2 3 4 5 11 22 1 23 4 56 7 8

AC IN

ON

OFF

TALLY/GPI 2

36 0

(1 4-

3/ 16

)

440 (17-5/16)

130 (5-1/8)

33 (1-5/16)

170 (6-11/16)

150

Specifications

Power supply: AC ( ) 100 V to 240 V, 50/60 Hz

Current consumption: 1.5 A

indicates safety information.

Video connectors

to terminals

8 lines (plus another maximum of 8 lines when using the OPTION unit) pp Connectors: BNC 8 pp Connectors to equipped with up-converters. pp Connectors to equipped with color correctors. pp SDI IN 1/2 excludes HDMI IN 1/2.

12G-SDI 12G-SDI, complied with SMPTE ST 2082-10 standard

3G-SDI 3G-SDI, complied with SMPTE292 standard (Compatible with Level-A/Level-B)

HD-SDI HD-SDI, complied with SMPTE292M standard

to terminals

2 lines (plus another maximum of 6 lines when using the OPTION unit) Video format inputs: 720p/59.94 Hz, 720p/50 Hz, 1080i/59.94 Hz, 1080i/50 Hz, 1080p/59.94 Hz, 1080p/50 Hz, 1080p/29.97 Hz, 1080p/25 Hz, 1080p/24 Hz, 1080p/23.98 Hz, 2160p/59.94 Hz, 2160p/50 Hz, 2160p/29.98 Hz (*), 2160p/25 Hz (*), 2160p/24 Hz (*), 2160p/23.98 Hz (*) pp Connectors: HDMI 2 pp This connector does not support the CPRM technologies. pp HDMI IN 1/2 excludes SDI IN 1/2.

*: Planned support with a firmware update

to terminals

5 lines (plus another maximum of 8 lines when using the OPTION unit) pp Connectors: BNC 5 pp PGM, PVW, CLN, ME PGM, MV1 to MV2, AUX1 to AUX4, Key Out can be assigned.

12G-SDI 12G-SDI, complied with SMPTE ST 2082-10 standard

3G-SDI 3G-SDI, complied with SMPTE292 standard (Compatible with Level-A)

HD-SDI HD-SDI, complied with SMPTE292M standard

to terminals

2 lines (plus another maximum of 6 lines when using the OPTION unit) Video format outputs: 720p/59.94 Hz, 720p/50 Hz, 1080i/59.94 Hz, 1080i/50 Hz, 1080p/59.94Hz, 1080p/50 Hz, 2160p/59.94 Hz, 2160p/50 Hz, 2160p/29.97 Hz (*), 2160p/25 Hz (*), 2160p/24 Hz (*), 2160p/23.98 Hz (*) pp Connectors :HDMI 2 pp PGM, PVW, CLN, ME PGM, MV1 to MV2, AUX1 to AUX4, Key Out can be assigned.

*: Planned support with a firmware update

Signal formats 2160/59.94P, 50P, 29.97P (*), 25P (*), 24P (*), 23.98P (*), 1080/59.94P, 50P, 29.97Psf, 25Psf, 24Psf, 23.98Psf, 59.94i, 50i, 720/59.94P, 50P *: Planned support with a firmware update

Signal processing R: G: B 4: 4: 4 10 bit/4: 2: 2 10 bit

Y: PB: PR 4: 2: 2 10 bit

ME number 1ME

151

Synchronizing connectors

terminal Reference input/ BB outputs

In Genlock mode: Black burst or Tri-level Sync input signals (with loop-through) pp Loop-through output is performed in external sync mode. pp If loop-through output is not going to be used, provide a 75 termination. pp Connectors : BNC pp Same field frequencies as those of the system formats supported. ppWith the 1080/24PsF format, only Genlock mode supported. ppWith the 1080/23.98PsF format, black burst with 10 Field ID (SMPTE318M standard met) or Tri- level Sync signals supported. pp BB signals are output from two connectors in the internal sync mode.

Video delay time 1 line (H) When the frame synchronizer setting is [Off] and neither the up-converter nor the down-converter is operating

1 frame (F) When the frame synchronizer setting is on and the up-converter and down- converter are operating

ppWhen the signals have passed through PinP, DVE, multi view, down-converter or HDMI IN, a maximum delay of 1 frame is applied in each case.

Control connectors

terminal Compatible with 1000Base-TX and AUTO-MDIX (For IP control) pp Connecting cable: LAN cable (CAT5E), max. 100 m (328 ft), STP (Shielded Twisted Pair) cable recommended pp Connectors : RJ-45

terminal INPUT: 8 inputs, general-purpose, photocoupler sensing OUTPUT: 19 outputs, selected from R/G tally, general-purpose ALARM: 1 output, open collector output (negative logic)

Other

Ambient operating temperature

0 C to 40 C (32 F to 104 F)

Ambient operating humidity

10% to 90% (no condensation)

Storage temperature 0 C to 40 C (32 F to 104 F)

Storage humidity 10% to 90% (no condensation)

Mass Approx. 7 kg (15.4 lb)

Dimensions

(W H D)

440 mm 170 mm 360 mm (17-5/16 inches 6-11/16 inches 14-3/16 inches) (excluding protrusions)

Specifications

152

Setting menu table pp Settings for items indicated with () are reflected when the item is selected and [F2], [F3], [F4] or [F5] is pressed.

Menu Sub menu Parameter 1 Parameter 2 Parameter 3 Parameter 4

Use [F1] to select. Use [F2] to select. Use [F3] to select. Use [F4] to select. Use [F5] to select. Background Border Parameter Border Width Soft

Setting range On, Off 0.1 to 100.0 0.0 to 100.0

Default value Off 5.0 0.0

Border Color Parameter Hue Sat Lum Load

Setting range 0.0 to 359.9 0.0 to 100.0 0.0 to 108.0 White, Yellow, Cyan, Green, Magenta, Red, Blue, Black

Default value 0.0 0.0 100.0 White

Position Parameter X-Pos Y-Pos Copy To Key

Setting range 100.00 to 100.00

100.00 to 100.00

Execute

Default value 0.00 0.00

Modify Parameter Trim

Setting range Off, 16:9, 4:3, 4:3 Smooth

Default value Off

3D Modify Parameter Light Size Radius Angle

Setting range On, Off 0.0 to 100.0 0.000 to 1.000 45 to 45

Default value Off 100.0 0.500 0

153

Menu Sub menu Parameter 1 Parameter 2 Parameter 3 Parameter 4

Use [F1] to select. Use [F2] to select. Use [F3] to select. Use [F4] to select. Use [F5] to select. Color Background CBGD1 Main Parameter Hue Sat Lum Load

Setting range 0.0 to 359.9 0.0 to 100.0 0.0 to 108.0 White, Yellow, Cyan, Green, Magenta, Red, Blue, Black

Default value 120.0 100.0 100.0 Blue

CBGD1 Sub Parameter Hue Sat Lum Load

Setting range 0.0 to 359.9 0.0 to 100.0 0.0 to 108.0 White, Yellow, Cyan, Green, Magenta, Red, Blue, Black

Default value 0.0 0.0 100.0 White

CBGD1 Wash Parameter Wash Color R-Sat R-Lum

Setting range On, Off Dual, Rainbow 0.0 to 100.0 0.0 to 108.0

Default value Off Dual 100.0 100.0

CBGD1 Wave Parameter Pattern Cycle Phase Angle

Setting range Sine, Saw 0 to 100 180.0 to 180.0 0.0 to 360.0

Default value Sine 0 0.0 0.0

CBGD1 Move Parameter Move Speed

Setting range Off, Roll, Rotation

50.0 to 50.0

Default value Off 1.0

CBGD2 Main Parameter Hue Sat Lum Load

Setting range 0.0 to 359.9 0.0 to 100.0 0.0 to 108.0 White, Yellow, Cyan, Green, Magenta, Red, Blue, Black

Default value 0.0 100.0 100.0 Red

CBGD2 Sub Parameter Hue Sat Lum Load

Setting range 0.0 to 359.9 0.0 to 100.0 0.0 to 108.0 White, Yellow, Cyan, Green, Magenta, Red, Blue, Black

Default value 0.0 0.0 100.0 White

CBGD2 Wash Parameter Wash Color R-Sat R-Lum

Setting range On, Off Dual, Rainbow 0.0 to 100.0 0.0 to 108.0

Default value Off Dual 100.0 100.0

CBGD2 Wave Parameter Pattern Cycle Phase Angle

Setting range Sine, Saw 0 to 100 180.0 to 180.0 0.0 to 360.0

Default value Sine 0 0.0 0.0

CBGD2 Move Parameter Move Speed

Setting range Off, Roll, Rotation

50.0 to 50.0

Default value Off 1.0

Setting menu table

154

Menu Sub menu Parameter 1 Parameter 2 Parameter 3 Parameter 4

Use [F1] to select. Use [F2] to select. Use [F3] to select. Use [F4] to select. Use [F5] to select. Key1 Key1 Parameter Type Lum Key Fill PVW

Setting range Lum, Linear, Chroma, Full

Chroma On, Chroma Off

Bus, Matte Auto, Off, On

Default value Linear Chroma Off Bus Auto

Adjust Parameter Clip Gain Density Invert

Setting range 0.0 to 108.0 0.0 to 200.0 0.0 to 100.0 On, Off

Default value 0.0 100.0 100.0 Off

Fill Matte Parameter Hue Sat Lum Load

Setting range 0.0 to 359.9 0.0 to 100.0 0.0 to 108.0 White, Yellow, Cyan, Green, Magenta, Red, Blue, Black

Default value 0.0 0.0 100.0 White

Edge1 Parameter Type Width Direction Density

Setting range Off, Border, Drop, Shadow, Outline

0 to 4 0, 45, 90, 135, 180, 225, 270, 315

25%, 50%, 75%, 100%

Default value Off 2 0 100%

Edge2 Parameter Edge Fill

Setting range Color, CBGD1, CBGD2, Still1, Still2, Clip1, Clip2

Default value Color

Edge Color Parameter Hue Sat Lum Load

Setting range 0.0 to 359.9 0.0 to 100.0 0.0 to 108.0 White, Yellow, Cyan, Green, Magenta, Red, Blue, Black

Default value 0.0 0.0 100.0 White

Transition Parameter Keyout Pattern

Setting range Normal, Reverse

Default value Normal

Position Parameter X-Pos Y-Pos Copy To BKGD

Setting range 100.00 to 100.00

100.00 to 100.00

Execute

Default value 0.00 0.00

Flying Key Parameter X-Pos Y-Pos Size

Setting range 100.00 to 100.00

100.00 to 100.00

0.0 to 400.0

Default value 0.00 0.00 100.0

3D Modify Parameter Light Size Radius Angle

Setting range On, Off 0.0 to 100.0 0.000 to 1.000 45 to 45

Default value Off 100.0 0.500 0

Setting menu table

155

Menu Sub menu Parameter 1 Parameter 2 Parameter 3 Parameter 4

Use [F1] to select. Use [F2] to select. Use [F3] to select. Use [F4] to select. Use [F5] to select. Key1 Mask Parameter Mask Invert

Setting range Off, Manual, 4:3

On, Off

Default value Off Off

Mask Adjust Parameter Left Top Bottom Right

Setting range 50.00 to 50.00 50.00 to 50.00 50.00 to 50.00 50.00 to 50.00

Default value 25.00 25.00 25.00 25.00

PinP Parameter PinP Full Key Shape Density

Setting range On, Off On, Off Square, Circle, Heart, Flower, Star

0.0 to 100.0

Default value Off On Square 100.0

PinP Border Parameter Border Width Soft Mode

Setting range On, Off 0.1 to 100.0 0.0 to 100.0 Fix, Variable

Default value Off 5.0 0.0 Fix

PinP Position Parameter X-Pos Y-Pos Size

Setting range 100.00 to 100.00

100.00 to 100.00

0.0 to 100.0

Default value 0.00 0.00 25.0

PinP Trim Parameter Trim Pair Preset

Setting range Off, On (Disabled when set to anything other than Square)

On, Off 16:9, 12:9, 9:9, 7:9, 6:9, Manual

Default value Off Off 16:9

PinP Trim Adjust

Parameter Left Top Bottom Right

Setting range 50.00 to 50.00 50.00 to 50.00 50.00 to 50.00 50.00 to 50.00

Default value 50.00 50.00 50.00 50.00

PinP Sync Parameter Symmetry Copy To DSK1

Setting range Off, X, Y, Center, Same

Execute

Default value Off

Key Signal Coupling

Parameter Independent

Setting range On, Off

Default value Off

Key Priority Parameter Key1 Key2 Key3

Setting range 1st, 2nd, 3rd 1st, 2nd, 3rd 1st, 2nd, 3rd

Default value 3rd 2nd 1st

Key On Parameter Key1

Setting range On, Off

Default value Off

Setting menu table

156

Menu Sub menu Parameter 1 Parameter 2 Parameter 3 Parameter 4

Use [F1] to select. Use [F2] to select. Use [F3] to select. Use [F4] to select. Use [F5] to select. Key2 Key1 Parameter Type Lum Key Fill PVW

Setting range Lum, Linear, Full Chroma On, Chroma Off

Bus, Matte Off, On

Default value Linear Chroma Off Bus Off

Adjust Parameter Clip Gain Density Invert

Setting range 0.0 to 108.0 0.0 to 200.0 0.0 to 100.0 On, Off

Default value 0.0 100.0 100.0 Off

Fill Matte Parameter Hue Sat Lum Load

Setting range 0.0 to 359.9 0.0 to 100.0 0.0 to 108.0 White, Yellow, Cyan, Green, Magenta, Red, Blue, Black

Default value 0.0 0.0 100.0 White

Edge1 Parameter Type Width Direction Density

Setting range Off, Border, Drop, Shadow, Outline

0 to 4 0, 45, 90, 135, 180, 225, 270, 315

25%, 50%, 75%, 100%

Default value Off 2 0 100%

Edge2 Parameter Edge Fill

Setting range Color, CBGD1, CBGD2, Still1, Still2, Clip1, Clip2

Default value Color

Edge Color Parameter Hue Sat Lum Load

Setting range 0.0 to 359.9 0.0 to 100.0 0.0 to 108.0 White, Yellow, Cyan, Green, Magenta, Red, Blue, Black

Default value 0.0 0.0 100.0 White

Mask Parameter Mask Invert

Setting range Off, Manual, 4:3

On, Off

Default value Off Off

Mask Adjust Parameter Left Top Bottom Right

Setting range 50.00 to 50.00 50.00 to 50.00 50.00 to 50.00 50.00 to 50.00

Default value 25.00 25.00 25.00 25.00

PinP Parameter PinP Full Key Shape Density

Setting range On, Off On, Off Square, Circle, Heart, Flower, Star

0.0 to 100.0

Default value Off On Square 100.0

PinP Border Parameter Border Width Soft Mode

Setting range Off, On 0.1 to 100.0 0.0 to 100.0 Fix, Variable

Default value Off 5.0 0.0 Fix

PinP Position Parameter X-Pos Y-Pos Size

Setting range 100.00 to 100.00

100.00 to 100.00

0.00 to 100.00

Default value 0.00 0.00 25.00

Setting menu table

157

Menu Sub menu Parameter 1 Parameter 2 Parameter 3 Parameter 4

Use [F1] to select. Use [F2] to select. Use [F3] to select. Use [F4] to select. Use [F5] to select. Key2 PinP Trim Parameter Trim Pair Preset

Setting range Off, On (Disabled when set to anything other than Square)

Off, On 16:9, 12:9, 9:9, 7:9, 6:9, Manual

Default value Off Off 16:9

PinP Trim Adjust

Parameter Left Top Bottom Right

Setting range 50.00 to 50.00 50.00 to 50.00 50.00 to 50.00 50.00 to 50.00

Default value 40.00 40.00 40.00 40.00

PinP Sync Parameter Symmetry Copy To DSK1

Setting range Off, X, Y, Center, Same

Execute

Default value Off

Key Signal Coupling

Parameter Independent

Setting range On, Off

Default value Off

Key Priority Parameter Key1 Key2 Key3

Setting range 1st, 2nd, 3rd 1st, 2nd, 3rd 1st, 2nd, 3rd

Default value 3rd 2nd 1st

Key On Parameter Key2

Setting range On, Off

Default value Off

Key3 Key1 Parameter Type Lum Key Fill PVW

Setting range Lum, Linear, Full Chroma On, Chroma Off

Bus, Matte Off, On

Default value Linear Chroma Off Bus Off

Adjust Parameter Clip Gain Density Invert

Setting range 0.0 to 108.0 0.0 to 200.0 0.0 to 100.0 On, Off

Default value 0.0 100.0 100.0 Off

Fill Matte Parameter Hue Sat Lum Load

Setting range 0.0 to 359.9 0.0 to 100.0 0.0 to 108.0 White, Yellow, Cyan, Green, Magenta, Red, Blue, Black

Default value 0.0 0.0 100.0 White

Mask Parameter Mask Invert

Setting range Off, Manual, 4:3

On, Off

Default value Off Off

Mask Adjust Parameter Left Top Bottom Right

Setting range 50.00 to 50.00 50.00 to 50.00 50.00 to 50.00 50.00 to 50.00

Default value 25.00 25.00 25.00 25.00

Key Signal Coupling

Parameter Independent

Setting range On, Off

Default value Off

Key Priority Parameter Key1 Key2 Key3

Setting range 1st, 2nd, 3rd 1st, 2nd, 3rd 1st, 2nd, 3rd

Default value 3rd 2nd 1st

Key On Parameter Key2

Setting range On, Off

Default value Off

Setting menu table

158

Menu Sub menu Parameter 1 Parameter 2 Parameter 3 Parameter 4

Use [F1] to select. Use [F2] to select. Use [F3] to select. Use [F4] to select. Use [F5] to select. Chroma Key Chroma Key Parameter Select Key Type

Setting range Key1, DSK1 Linked to the Key Type of Key1 or DSK selected in Select

Default value Key1

Auto Compute Parameter Auto Compute Reset

Setting range Execute Execute

Default value

Adjust Parameter Narrow Phase

Setting range Off, 0.5, 1.0, 1.5

4.0 to 4.0

Default value Off 0.0

Sampling Parameter Chroma PVW Mode Sampling Undo

Setting range Off, Key1, DSK1 Select BG, Clean BG, Clean FG, Sponge, Fine Tuning

Execute Execute

Default value Off Select BG Color

Sampling Area Parameter X-Pos Y-Pos Size

Setting range 50.00 to 50.00 50.00 to 50.00 0.1 to 100.0

Default value 0.00 0.00 10.0

Fine Tuning Parameter Spill Trans Detail

Setting range 1000 to 1000 1000 to 1000 1000 to 1000

Default value 0 0 0

DSK1 DSK1 Parameter Type Lum Key Fill PVW

Setting range Lum, Linear, Chroma, Full

Chroma On, Chroma Off

Bus, Matte Off, On

Default value Linear Chroma Off Bus Off

Adjust Parameter Clip Gain Density Invert

Setting range 0.0 to 108.0 0.0 to 200.0 0.0 to 100.0 On, Off

Default value 0.0 100.0 100.0 Off

Fill Matte Parameter Hue Sat Lum Load

Setting range 0.0 to 359.9 0.0 to 100.0 0.0 to 108.0 White, Yellow, Cyan, Green, Magenta, Red, Blue, Black

Default value 0.0 0.0 100.0 White

Setting menu table

159

Menu Sub menu Parameter 1 Parameter 2 Parameter 3 Parameter 4

Use [F1] to select. Use [F2] to select. Use [F3] to select. Use [F4] to select. Use [F5] to select. DSK1 Mask Parameter Mask Invert

Setting range Off, Manual, 4:3

On, Off

Default value Off Off

Mask Adjust Parameter Left Top Bottom Right

Setting range 50.00 to 50.00 50.00 to 50.00 50.00 to 50.00 50.00 to 50.00

Default value 25.00 25.00 25.00 25.00

PinP Parameter PinP Full Key Shape Density

Setting range On, Off On, Off Square, Circle, Heart, Flower, Star

0.0 to 100.0

Default value Off On Square 100.0

PinP Border Parameter Border Width Soft Mode

Setting range Off, On 0.1 to 100.0 0.0 to 100.0 Fix, Variable

Default value Off 5.0 0.0 Fix

PinP Position Parameter X-Pos Y-Pos Size

Setting range 100.0 to 100.0 100.0 to 100.0 0.0 to 100.0

Default value 0.00 0.00 25.0

PinP Trim Parameter Trim Pair Preset

Setting range Off, On (Disabled when set to anything other than Square)

Off, On 16:9, 12:9, 9:9, 7:9, 6:9, Manual

Default value Off Off 16:9

PinP Trim Adjust

Parameter Left Top Bottom Right

Setting range 50.00 to 50.00 50.00 to 50.00 50.00 to 50.00 50.00 to 50.00

Default value 50.00 50.00 50.00 50.00

PinP Sync Parameter Symmetry Copy To Key2

Setting range Off, X, Y, Center, Same

Execute

Default value Off

DSK Priority Parameter DSK1 DSK2

Setting range 1st, 2nd 1st, 2nd

Default value 2nd 1st

DSK Signal Coupling

Parameter Independent

Setting range On, Off

Default value Off

DSK On Parameter DSK1

Setting range On, Off

Default value Off

Setting menu table

160

Menu Sub menu Parameter 1 Parameter 2 Parameter 3 Parameter 4

Use [F1] to select. Use [F2] to select. Use [F3] to select. Use [F4] to select. Use [F5] to select. DSK2 DSK1 Parameter Type Lum Key Fill PVW

Setting range Lum, Linear, Full Chroma On, Chroma Off

Bus, Matte Off, On

Default value Linear Chroma Off Bus Off

Adjust Parameter Clip Gain Density Invert

Setting range 0.0 to 108.0 0.0 to 200.0 0.0 to 100.0 On, Off

Default value 0.0 100.0 100.0 Off

Fill Matte Parameter Hue Sat Lum Load

Setting range 0.0 to 359.9 0.0 to 100.0 0.0 to 108.0 White, Yellow, Cyan, Green, Magenta, Red, Blue, Black

Default value 0.0 0.0 100.0 White

Mask Parameter Mask Invert

Setting range Off, Manual, 4:3

On, Off

Default value Off Off

Mask Adjust Parameter Left Top Bottom Right

Setting range 50.00 to 50.00 50.00 to 50.00 50.00 to 50.00 50.00 to 50.00

Default value 25.00 25.00 25.00 25.00

DSK Priority Parameter DSK1 DSK2

Setting range 1st, 2nd 1st, 2nd

Default value 2nd 1st

DSK Signal Coupling

Parameter Independent

Setting range On, Off

Default value Off

DSK On Parameter DSK2

Setting range On, Off

Default value Off

Setting menu table

161

Menu Sub menu Parameter 1 Parameter 2 Parameter 3 Parameter 4

Use [F1] to select. Use [F2] to select. Use [F3] to select. Use [F4] to select. Use [F5] to select. Time BKGD Parameter TransTime Time

Setting range 0 to 999 (Frame)

Default value 1s00f

Key1 Parameter TransTime Time

Setting range 0 to 999 (Frame)

Default value 1s00f

Key2 Parameter TransTime Time

Setting range 0 to 999 (Frame)

Default value 1s00f

Key3 Parameter TransTime Time

Setting range 0 to 999 (Frame)

Default value 1s00f

DSK1 Parameter TransTime Time

Setting range 0 to 999 (Frame)

Default value 1s00f

DSK2 Parameter TransTime Time

Setting range 0 to 999 (Frame)

Default value 1s00f

AUX1 BUS Trans

Parameter TransTime Time Transition

Setting range 0 to 999 (Frame)

On, Off

Default value 1s00f Off

AUX2 BUS Trans

Parameter TransTime Time Transition

Setting range 0 to 999 (Frame)

On, Off

Default value 1s00f Off

Effect Dissolve Parameter TransTime Time

Setting range 0 to 999 (Frame)

Default value 1s00f

FTB Parameter TransTime Time

Setting range 0 to 999 (Frame)

Default value 1s00f

Setting menu table

162

Menu Sub menu Parameter 1 Parameter 2 Parameter 3 Parameter 4

Use [F1] to select. Use [F2] to select. Use [F3] to select. Use [F4] to select. Use [F5] to select. Camera Camera

Information Parameter Input Selection Name Model Status

Setting range *1 *2 Model name of the camera is displayed if no camera is connected.

*3

Default value IN1 No IP Address

Camera Control

Parameter Power All Power On All Standby Z-Dial Usage

Setting range Standby, On Execute Execute P-T Sp. & Zoom, P-T Speed Only

Default value Undetermined (depends on the settings on the camera)

P-T Sp. & Zoom

Control Speed Parameter Pan & Tilt Zoom Focus Iris

Setting range 1 to 32 1 to 32 1 to 32 1 to 32

Default value 16 16 16 16

OSD Menu & Color Bars

Parameter OSD Menu Menu Operation

Color Bars

Setting range On, Off (Turn or Push) On, Off

Default value Undetermined (depends on the settings on the camera)

Undetermined (depends on the settings on the camera)

Lens Control Parameter Auto Focus Auto Iris

Setting range On, Off On, Off

Default value Undetermined (depends on the settings on the camera)

Undetermined (depends on the settings on the camera)

AWB Parameter AWB Last AWB Result

AWB Mode

Setting range Execute , Successful, Failed

ATW, AWB A, AWB B, 3200K, 5600K, VAR

Default value Undetermined (depends on the settings on the camera)

*1: IN1, IN2, SDI IN3, SDI IN4, SDI IN5, SDI IN6, SDI IN7, SDI IN8, HDMI IN1, HDMI IN2, SlotA HDMI IN board is inserted: IN-A1, IN-A2, IN-A3, SlotA SDI IN board is inserted: IN-A1, IN-A2, IN-A3, IN-A4, SlotB HDMI IN board is inserted: IN-B1, IN-B2, IN-B3 SlotB SDI IN board is inserted: IN-B1, IN-B2, IN-B3, IN-B4

*2: Name registered on the camera. When a camera is not connected, is displayed. When the camera name is just a single space, (Standby Mode) is displayed.

*3: No IP Address, Now Checking..., Connected, Unauthorized, Not Connected, Please Wait..., Pan & Tilt Alarm, Fan Alarm, Other Alarm

Setting menu table

163

Menu Sub menu Parameter 1 Parameter 2 Parameter 3 Parameter 4

Use [F1] to select. Use [F2] to select. Use [F3] to select. Use [F4] to select. Use [F5] to select. Camera ABB Parameter ABB Last ABB

Result

Setting range Execute , Successful, Failed

Default value

Gain1 Parameter Gain R Gain B Gain

Setting range *1 *2

Default value Undetermined (depends on the settings on the camera)

Undetermined (depends on the settings on the camera)

Undetermined (depends on the settings on the camera)

Gain2 Parameter AGC Max Gain Super Gain

Setting range *3 ON, OFF

Default value Undetermined (depends on the settings on the camera)

Undetermined (depends on the settings on the camera)

Pedestal Parameter M Ped. R Ped. G Ped. B Ped.

Setting range *4 100 to 100 100 to 100 100 to 100

Default value Undetermined (depends on the settings on the camera)

Undetermined (depends on the settings on the camera)

Undetermined (depends on the settings on the camera)

Undetermined (depends on the settings on the camera)

Preset Settings Parameter Preset Scope Speed Preset Sp. Unit Preset Sp.Table

Setting range Mode A, Mode B, Mode C

*5 Speed Table, Time

Slow, Fast

Default value Undetermined (depends on the settings on the camera)

Undetermined (depends on the settings on the camera)

Undetermined (depends on the settings on the camera)

Undetermined (depends on the settings on the camera)

Lock Parameter Pan & Tilt Lock Zoom Lock Focus Lock Iris Lock

Setting range On, Off On, Off On, Off On, Off

Default value Off Off Off Off

*1: AW-UE150/AW-HR140: 0 to 42 dB, AGC (Super Gain: ON), 0 to 36 dB, AGC (Super Gain: OFF) AW-HE130/AW-HN130: 0 to 36 dB, AGC AW-UE70/AW-UN70/AW-HE40/AW-HN40/AW-HE42: 0, 3, , 48 dB (3 dB increments), AGC

*2: AW-UE150: 200 to 200 AW-HR140/AW-HE130/AW-HN130: 150 to 150 AW-UE70/AW-UN70/AW-HE40/AW-HN40/AW-HE42: 30 to 30

*3: AW-UE150: 200 to 200 AW-HR140/AW-HE130/AW-HN130: 150 to 150 AW-UE70/AW-UN70/AW-HE40/AW-HN40/AW-HE42: 10 to 10

*4: AW-UE150/AW-HR140/AW-HE130/AW-HN130: 6 dB, 12 dB, 18 dB AW-UE70/AW-UN70/AW-HE40/AW-HN40/AW-HE42: 6 dB, 12 dB, 18 dB, 24 dB, 30 dB, 36 dB, 42 dB, 48 dB

*5: AW-UE150: 1 to 30 (Preset Sp.Unit: Speed Table) 1 to 99 (Preset Sp.Unit: Time) Other than AW-UE150: 1 to 30

Project File Last Load File Parameter Media File Name

Setting range

Default value Display only Display only

Last Load Date Parameter Date

Setting range

Default value Display only

Project File Parameter Load Save Delete Rename

Setting range Execute Execute Execute Execute

Default value

Target Select1 Parameter Setup Shot Event Macro

Setting range On, Off On, Off On, Off On, Off

Default value On On On On

Target Select2 Parameter Still Clip

Setting range On, Off On, Off

Default value Off Off

Setting menu table

164

Menu Sub menu Parameter 1 Parameter 2 Parameter 3 Parameter 4

Use [F1] to select. Use [F2] to select. Use [F3] to select. Use [F4] to select. Use [F5] to select. SD Card Card

Management Parameter Mount Umount Format

Setting range Execute Execute Execute

Default value

Mode Parameter Load Delete Rename Sort

Setting range Execute Execute Execute Newest, Oldest, Name

Default value Name

File Parameter Save Save Type Format

Setting range Execute Still1, Still2, Clip1, Clip2, Project, Log

bmp, tga, png, jpeg, tif, gif

Default value Project png

Target Select1 Parameter Setup Shot Event Macro

Setting range On, Off On, Off On, Off On, Off

Default value On On On On

Target Select2 Parameter Still Clip

Setting range On, Off On, Off

Default value Off Off

Create Thumbnail

Parameter Still Clip

Setting range Execute Execute

Default value

Card Information

Parameter Free Total

Setting range

Default value

Setting menu table

165

Menu Sub menu Parameter 1 Parameter 2 Parameter 3 Parameter 4

Use [F1] to select. Use [F2] to select. Use [F3] to select. Use [F4] to select. Use [F5] to select. Video Memory

When Still1, Sitll2

Video Memory1

Parameter Select Rec Key

Setting range Still1, Still2, Clip1, Clip2

Execute On, Off

Default value Still1

Rec1 Parameter VMEM Video VMEM Key

Setting range AUX1 to 4 AUX1 to 4

Default value AUX1 AUX1

Rec2 Parameter Preview Key Enable Review

Setting range On, Off On, Off On, Off

Default value Off On On

Memory Parameter Mode Select Save

Setting range Auto, Manual Still1, Still2, Clip1, Clip2, All

Execute

Default value Auto All

Video Memory

When Clip1, Clip2

Video Memory1

Parameter Select Rec Play Stop

Setting range Still1, Still2, Clip1, Clip2

Execute Execute Execute

Default value Still1

Video Memory2

Parameter LEAD LAST

Setting range Execute Execute

Default value

Video Memory3

Parameter Total Time Current Time Key Rec Lock

Setting range The setting range differs with each format.

On, Off On, Off

Default value On

Rec1 Parameter VMEM Video VMEM Key

Setting range AUX1 to 4 AUX1 to 4

Default value AUX1 AUX1

Rec2 Parameter Preview Key Enable Review

Setting range On, Off On, Off On, Off

Default value Off On On

Rec3 Parameter Loop Quality Audio

Setting range On, Off High, Standard On, Off

Default value Off Standard On

Limit Time Parameter Mode

Setting range 1f to 2m00s00f (when 59.94i)

Default value 5s00f

Play Mode1 Parameter Mode Reverse Variable Freeze

Setting range Lead, Last, Loop On, Off x1, x2, x4, x8, x1/2, x1/4, x1/8

Frame, Field

Default value Last Off x1 Frame

Play Mode2 Parameter Trans Sync Audio

Setting range Off, Auto, KEY1 ON, KEY2 ON, KEY3 ON, DSK1 ON, DSK2 ON, FTB ON

On, Off

Default value Off On

Memory Parameter Mode Select Save

Setting range Auto, Manual Still1, Still2, Clip1, Clip2, All

Execute

Default value Auto All

Setting menu table

166

Menu Sub menu Parameter 1 Parameter 2 Parameter 3 Parameter 4

Use [F1] to select. Use [F2] to select. Use [F3] to select. Use [F4] to select. Use [F5] to select. Macro Store Select1 Parameter ME DSK AUX

Setting range On, Off On, Off On, Off

Default value On On On

Store Select2 Parameter MENU XPT OTHER

Setting range On, Off On, Off On, Off

Default value On On On

Insert Delay Parameter Time Set

Setting range 0 to 600 (Frame) Execute

Default value 1s00f

Macro Assign 1/6

Parameter XPT1 XPT2 XPT3 XPT4

Setting range Macro1 to Macro100, PlayCancel, No Assign

Macro1 to Macro100, PlayCancel, No Assign

Macro1 to Macro100, PlayCancel, No Assign

Macro1 to Macro100, PlayCancel, No Assign

Default value No Assign No Assign No Assign No Assign

Macro Assign 2/6

Parameter XPT5 XPT6 XPT7 XPT8

Setting range Macro1 to Macro100, PlayCancel, No Assign

Macro1 to Macro100, PlayCancel, No Assign

Macro1 to Macro100, PlayCancel, No Assign

Macro1 to Macro100, PlayCancel, No Assign

Default value No Assign No Assign No Assign No Assign

Macro Assign 3/6

Parameter XPT9 XPT10 XPT11 XPT12

Setting range Macro1 to Macro100, PlayCancel, No Assign

Macro1 to Macro100, PlayCancel, No Assign

Macro1 to Macro100, PlayCancel, No Assign

Macro1 to Macro100, PlayCancel, No Assign

Default value No Assign No Assign No Assign No Assign

Macro Assign 4/6

Parameter XPT13 XPT14 XPT15 XPT16

Setting range Macro1 to Macro100, PlayCancel, No Assign

Macro1 to Macro100, PlayCancel, No Assign

Macro1 to Macro100, PlayCancel, No Assign

Macro1 to Macro100, PlayCancel, No Assign

Default value No Assign No Assign No Assign No Assign

Macro Assign 5/6

Parameter XPT17 XPT18 XPT19 XPT20

Setting range Macro1 to Macro100, PlayCancel, No Assign

Macro1 to Macro100, PlayCancel, No Assign

Macro1 to Macro100, PlayCancel, No Assign

Macro1 to Macro100, PlayCancel, No Assign

Default value No Assign No Assign No Assign No Assign

Macro Assign 6/6

Parameter XPT21 XPT22 XPT23 XPT24

Setting range Macro1 to Macro100, PlayCancel, No Assign

Macro1 to Macro100, PlayCancel, No Assign

Macro1 to Macro100, PlayCancel, No Assign

Macro1 to Macro100, PlayCancel, No Assign

Default value No Assign No Assign No Assign No Assign

Setting menu table

167

Menu Sub menu Parameter 1 Parameter 2 Parameter 3 Parameter 4

Use [F1] to select. Use [F2] to select. Use [F3] to select. Use [F4] to select. Use [F5] to select. Shot Memory Target Select1 Parameter ME DSK AUX

Setting range On, Off On, Off On, Off

Default value On On On

Target Select2 Parameter CBGD

Setting range On, Off

Default value On

Register Parameter Page No. Rename Copy To

Setting range 1 to 10 1 to 10 Execute 1 to 10 Default value 1 1 1

Path Parameter Effect PinP Bus Hue Path

Setting range Cut, Dissolve Cut, Dissolve Short, Long, CW, CCW

Default value Dissolve Dissolve Short

Event Memory Mark Parameter PAUSE CLIP GPI-Out

Setting range On, Off Off, Clip1, Clip2 Off, EMEM-01 to EMEM-20

Default value Off Off Off

Event Duration Parameter (Time) Set

Setting range 0 to 215999 (Frame)

Execute

Default value 1s00f

Total Duration Parameter (Time) Set

Setting range 0 to 215999 (Frame)

Execute

Default value 1s00f

Timeline Parameter View

Setting range Normal, Wide

Default value Wide

Play Parameter Loop Play Mode

Setting range Once, Loop Normal, Reverse

Default value Once Normal

Target Select1 Parameter ME DSK AUX

Setting range On, Off On, Off On, Off

Default value On On On

Target Select2 Parameter CBGD CLIP

Setting range On, Off On, Off

Default value On On

Register Parameter Page No. Rename Copy To

Setting range 1 to 10 1 to 10 Execute 1 to 100

Default value 1 1 1

Path Parameter Trans Path Hue Path

Setting range Linear, Spline, Step

Short, Long, CW, CCW, Step

Default value Linear CW

Setting menu table

168

Menu Sub menu Parameter 1 Parameter 2 Parameter 3 Parameter 4

Use [F1] to select. Use [F2] to select. Use [F3] to select. Use [F4] to select. Use [F5] to select. XPT XPT Assign 1/6 Parameter XPT1 Signal XPT2 Signal XPT3 Signal XPT4 Signal

Setting range IN1, IN2, SDI IN3 to 8, IN-A1, IN-A2, IN-A3, IN-A4, IN-B1, IN-B2, IN- B3, IN-B4, Black, CBGD 1, CBGD 2, CBAR, Still 1V, Still 1K, Still 2V, Still 2K, Clip 1V, Clip 1K, Clip 2V, Clip 2K, CLN, ME PGM, Key Out, None

Default value IN1 IN2 SDI IN3 SDI IN4

XPT Assign 2/6 Parameter XPT5 Signal XPT6 Signal XPT7 Signal XPT8 Signal

Setting range The setting range is the same as for the XPT Assign 1/6 sub menu. Default value SDI IN5 SDI IN6 SDI IN7 SDI IN8

XPT Assign 3/6 Parameter XPT9 Signal XPT10 Signal XPT11 Signal XPT12 Signal

Setting range The setting range is the same as for the XPT Assign 1/6 sub menu. Default value CBAR CBGD 1 CBGD 2 None

XPT Assign 4/6 Parameter XPT13 Signal XPT14 Signal XPT15 Signal XPT16 Signal

Setting range The setting range is the same as for the XPT Assign 1/6 sub menu. Default value None None None None

XPT Assign 5/6 Parameter XPT17 Signal XPT18 Signal XPT19 Signal XPT20 Signal

Setting range The setting range is the same as for the XPT Assign 1/6 sub menu. Default value None None None None

XPT Assign 6/6 Parameter XPT21 Signal XPT22 Signal XPT23 Signal XPT24 Signal

Setting range The setting range is the same as for the XPT Assign 1/6 sub menu. Default value None None None None

XPT Setting Parameter Shift Shift-Lock

Setting range Off, Right, Left On, Off

Default value Right Off

XPT Switch Parameter Timing

Setting range Any, Field1, Field2

Default value Any

Multi View Display Parameter Select

Setting range MV1, MV2

Default value MV1

Setting menu table

169

Menu Sub menu Parameter 1 Parameter 2 Parameter 3 Parameter 4

Use [F1] to select. Use [F2] to select. Use [F3] to select. Use [F4] to select. Use [F5] to select. Multi View Display

When MV1

MV1 Split Parameter Split

Setting range 4Split, 5-aSplit, 5-bSplit, 6-aSplit, 6-bSplit, 9Split, 10-aSplit, 10-bSplit, 12Split, 16Split

Default value 10-aSplit

MV1 Pattern 1/4

Parameter Pos1 Signal Pos2 Signal Pos3 Signal Pos4 Signal

Setting range IN1, IN2, SDI IN3, SDI IN4, SDI IN5, SDI IN6, SDI IN7, SDI IN8, IN- A1, IN-A2, IN-A3, IN-A4, IN-B1, IN-B2, IN-B3, IN-B4, CBGD 1, CBGD 2, Still 1V, Still 1K, Still 2V, Still 2K, Clip 1V, Clip 1K, Clip 2V, Clip 2K, PGM, PVW, CLN, ME PGM, Key Out, MV1, MV2, AUX1, AUX2, AUX3, AUX4, Clock

Default value PGM PVW IN1 IN2

MV1 Pattern 2/4

Parameter Pos5 Signal Pos6 Signal Pos7 Signal Pos8 Signal

Setting range The setting range is the same as for the MV1 Pattern 1/4 sub menu. Default value SDI IN3 SDI IN4 SDI IN5 SDI IN6

MV1 Pattern 3/4

Parameter Pos9 Signal Pos10 Signal Pos11 Signal Pos12 Signal

Setting range The setting range is the same as for the MV1 Pattern 1/4 sub menu. Default value SDI IN7 SDI IN8 Still 1V Still 2V

MV1 Pattern 4/4

Parameter Pos13 Signal Pos14 Signal Pos15 Signal Pos16 Signal

Setting range The setting range is the same as for the MV1 Pattern 1/4 sub menu. Default value Clip 1V Clip 2V AUX1 AUX2

MV1 Frame Parameter Frame Character Label

Setting range LUM0%, LUM25%, LUM50%, LUM75%, LUM100%, Off

On, Off

Default value LUM75% On

MV1 Tally Group1

Parameter Box Label Left Label Right

Setting range On, Off On, Off On, Off

Default value Off Off Off

MV1 Tally Group2

Parameter Box Label Left Label Right

Setting range On, Off On, Off On, Off

Default value Off Off Off

Display Parameter Level Meter Input Status Marker Marker Size

Setting range On, Off On, Off 4:3, 16:9, Off 80 to 100%

Default value Off On Off 95%

Setting menu table

170

Menu Sub menu Parameter 1 Parameter 2 Parameter 3 Parameter 4

Use [F1] to select. Use [F2] to select. Use [F3] to select. Use [F4] to select. Use [F5] to select. Multi View Display

When MV2

MV2 Split Parameter Split

Setting range 4Split, 5-aSplit, 5-bSplit, 6-aSplit, 6-bSplit, 9Split, 10-aSplit, 10-bSplit, 12Split, 16Split

Default value 10-aSplit

MV2 Pattern 1/4

Parameter Pos1 Signal Pos2 Signal Pos3 Signal Pos4 Signal

Setting range IN1, IN2, SDI IN3, SDI IN4, SDI IN5, SDI IN6, SDI IN7, SDI IN8, IN- A1, IN-A2, IN-A3, IN-A4, IN-B1, IN-B2, IN-B3, IN-B4, CBGD 1, CBGD 2, Still 1V, Still 1K, Still 2V, Still 2K, Clip 1V, Clip 1K, Clip 2V, Clip 2K, PGM, PVW, CLN, ME PGM, Key Out, MV1, MV2, AUX1, AUX2, AUX3, AUX4, Clock

Default value IN1 IN2 CBGD 1 CBGD 2

MV2 Pattern 2/4

Parameter Pos5 Signal Pos6 Signal Pos7 Signal Pos8 Signal

Setting range The setting range is the same as for the MV2 Pattern 1/4 sub menu. Default value CBAR Black Still 1K Still 2K

MV2 Pattern 3/4

Parameter Pos9 Signal Pos10 Signal Pos11 Signal Pos12 Signal

Setting range The setting range is the same as for the MV2 Pattern 1/4 sub menu. Default value Clip 1K Clip 2K CLN ME PGM

MV2 Pattern 4/4

Parameter Pos13 Signal Pos14 Signal Pos15 Signal Pos16 Signal

Setting range The setting range is the same as for the MV2 Pattern 1/4 sub menu. Default value Key Out AUX3 AUX4 Clock

MV2 Frame Parameter Frame Character Label

Setting range LUM0%, LUM25%, LUM50%, LUM75%, LUM100%, Off

On, Off

Default value LUM75% On

MV2 Tally Red Parameter Box Label Left Label Right

Setting range On, Off On, Off On, Off

Default value Off Off Off

MV2 Tally Green

Parameter Box Label Left Label Right

Setting range On, Off On, Off On, Off

Default value Off Off Off

Display Parameter Level Meter Input Status Marker Marker Size

Setting range On, Off On, Off 4:3, 16:9, Off 80 to 100%

Default value Off On Off 95%

Input Input Parameter Select Color Space SDI/HDMI

Setting range IN1, IN2, SDI IN3, SDI IN4, SDI IN5, SDI IN6, SDI IN7, SDI IN8, IN-A1, IN-A2, IN-A3, IN-A4, IN-B1, IN-B2, IN- B3, IN-B4

HDR BT.2020, HDR BT.709, SDR BT.709

SDI IN, HDMI IN

Default value IN1 SDR BT.709 SDI IN

Setting menu table

171

Menu Sub menu Parameter 1 Parameter 2 Parameter 3 Parameter 4

Use [F1] to select. Use [F2] to select. Use [F3] to select. Use [F4] to select. Use [F5] to select. Input (SDI) / X(***)

p IN1, IN2, SDI IN3 to 8, IN-A1 to 4 or IN-B1 to 4 is displayed in the X part. p The material name

(up to 32 characters) is displayed in the *** part.

Status Parameter Format Audio Color Space

Setting range

Default value

FS Parameter Mode Delay

Setting range Off, Normal, Auto

0F to 8F

Default value Auto 0F

Freeze Parameter Select Freeze

Setting range Frame, Field On, Off

Default value Frame Off

Name Parameter Type Name

Setting range Default, User

Default value Default

Up/Down Converter

Parameter Move Detect Sharp

Setting range 1 to 5 1 to 5

Default value 3 3

C/C Operation Parameter C/C Limit

Setting range On, Off Off, 108, 104, 100

Default value Off Off

C/C Process Parameter Y-Gain Pedestal C-Gain Hue

Setting range 0.0 to 200.0 20.0 to 200.0 0.0 to 200.0 0.0 to 359.9

Default value 100.0 0.0 100.0 0.0

C/C Tone1 Black

Parameter Red Green Blue RGB Link

Setting range 10.0 to 108.0 10.0 to 108.0 10.0 to 108.0 On, Off

Default value 0.0 0.0 0.0 Off

C/C Tone2 Gray L

Parameter Red Green Blue

Setting range 10.0 to 108.0 10.0 to 108.0 10.0 to 108.0 Default value 33.3 33.3 33.3

C/C Tone3 Gray H

Parameter Red Green Blue

Setting range 10.0 to 108.0 10.0 to 108.0 10.0 to 108.0 Default value 66.6 66.6 66.6

C/C Tone4 White

Parameter Red Green Blue

Setting range 10.0 to 108.0 10.0 to 108.0 10.0 to 108.0 Default value 100.0 100.0 100.0

C/C Matrix R/G Parameter R-G R-B G-R G-B

Setting range 0.60 to 0.60 0.60 to 0.60 0.60 to 0.60 0.60 to 0.60

Default value 0.00 0.00 0.00 0.00

C/C Matrix B Parameter B-R B-G

Setting range 0.60 to 0.60 0.60 to 0.60

Default value 0.00 0.00

C/C Setting Parameter Init Target Initialize Copy Target Copy From

Setting range Process, Tone, RGB Matrix, All

Execute SDI IN5, SDI IN6, SDI IN7, SDI IN8, IN- A1, IN-A2, IN-A3, IN-A4, IN-B1, IN-B2, IN-B3, IN-B4

Execute

Default value All SDI IN5

Setting menu table

172

Menu Sub menu Parameter 1 Parameter 2 Parameter 3 Parameter 4

Use [F1] to select. Use [F2] to select. Use [F3] to select. Use [F4] to select. Use [F5] to select. Input (HDMI) / X(***)

p IN1, IN2, IN-A1 to 4 or IN-B1 to 4 is displayed in the X part. p The material name

(up to 10 characters) is displayed in the *** part.

Freeze Parameter Select Freeze

Setting range Frame, Field On, Off

Default value Frame Off

Limited Parameter Limited

Setting range On, Off

Default value Off

Name Parameter Type Name

Setting range Default, User

Default value Default

HDMI Input Parameter Scale

Setting range Fit-V, Fit-H, Full

Default value Full

HDMI Status Parameter Size Dot Clock H-Frequency V-Frequency

Setting range

Default value ****x**** ***.*MHz **.*kHz **.*Hz

C/C Operation Parameter C/C Limit

Setting range On, Off Off, 108, 104, 100

Default value Off Off

C/C Process Parameter Y-Gain Pedestal C-Gain Hue

Setting range 0.0 to 200.0 20.0 to 200.0 0.0 to 200.0 0.0 to 359.9 Default value 100.0 0.0 100.0 0.0

C/C Tone1 Black

Parameter Red Green Blue RGB Link

Setting range 10.0 to 108.0 10.0 to 108.0 10.0 to 108.0 On, Off

Default value 0.0 0.0 0.0 Off

C/C Tone2 Gray L

Parameter Red Green Blue

Setting range 10.0 to 108.0 10.0 to 108.0 10.0 to 108.0 Default value 33.3 33.3 33.3

C/C Tone3 Gray H

Parameter Red Green Blue

Setting range 10.0 to 108.0 10.0 to 108.0 10.0 to 108.0 Default value 66.6 66.6 66.6

C/C Tone4 White

Parameter Red Green Blue

Setting range 10.0 to 108.0 10.0 to 108.0 10.0 to 108.0 Default value 100.0 100.0 100.0

C/C Matrix R/G Parameter R-G R-B G-R G-B

Setting range 0.60 to 0.60 0.60 to 0.60 0.60 to 0.60 0.60 to 0.60 Default value 0.00 0.00 0.00 0.00

C/C Matrix B Parameter B-R B-G

Setting range 0.60 to 0.60 0.60 to 0.60 Default value 0.00 0.00

C/C Setting Parameter Init Target Initialize Copy Target Copy From

Setting range Process, Tone, RGB Matrix, All

Execute IN-A1, IN-A2, IN-A3, IN-B1, IN-B2, IN-B3

Execute

Default value All

Setting menu table

173

Menu Sub menu Parameter 1 Parameter 2 Parameter 3 Parameter 4

Use [F1] to select. Use [F2] to select. Use [F3] to select. Use [F4] to select. Use [F5] to select. Input Camera

Settings1 Parameter IP Address Port Edit IP Address Scan IP

Address

Setting range Need Edit/Scan Now Scanning Not Detected Select From List

1 to 65535 Execute Execute

Default value Need Edit/Scan 80

Camera Settings2

Parameter Edit User Name

Edit Password Name Network Status

Setting range Execute Execute Name registered on the camera

No IP Address, Now Checking..., Connected, Unauthorized, Not Connected

Default value No IP Address

Camera Settings3

Parameter Pan Direction Tilt Direction Tally (Group1)

Setting range Normal, Reverse Normal, Reverse Disable, Enable

Default value Normal Normal Enable

Camera Settings4

Parameter Zoom Direction

Focus Direction Iris Direction

Setting range Normal, Reverse Normal, Reverse Normal, Reverse

Default value Normal Normal Normal

Output Output Parameter Select Mode Color Space

Setting range SDI OUT1, SDI OUT2 , SDI OUT3, SDI OUT4, SDI OUT5, HDMI OUT1, HDMI OUT2, OUT-A1, OUT-A2, OUT-A3, OUT-A4, OUT-B1, OUT-B2, OUT-B3, OUT-B4

Normal, 1080p, 1080i, 720p

HDR BT.2020, HDR BT.709, SDR BT.709

Default value SDI OUT1 Normal SDR BT.709

Output (SDI) / Y

p SDI OUT1 to SDI OUT5, OUT A1, OUT A2, OUT A3, OUT A4, OUT B1, OUT B2, OUT B3 or OUT B4 is displayed in the Y part.

(OUT A1, OUT A2, OUT A3, OUT A4, OUT B1, OUT B2, OUT B3 and OUT B4 take effect when the AV- UHS5M2 unit has been connected.)

Assign Parameter Source

Setting range PGM, PVW, CLN, ME PGM, AUX1, AUX2, AUX3, AUX4, MV1, MV2, Key Out

Default value PGM(OUT1), PVW(OUT2), AUX1(OUT3), AUX2(OUT4), AUX3(OUT5), AUX4(OUTA1), AUX1(OUTA2), AUX2(OUTA3), AUX3(OUTB1), AUX4(OUTB2), AUX1(OUTB3)

Normal

Down Converter

Parameter Delay Sharp

Setting range Minimum, 1F Fix

1 to 5

Default value Minimum 3

Setting menu table

174

Menu Sub menu Parameter 1 Parameter 2 Parameter 3 Parameter 4

Use [F1] to select. Use [F2] to select. Use [F3] to select. Use [F4] to select. Use [F5] to select. Output (HDMI) / Y

p HDMI OUT1, HDMI OUT2, OUT A1, OUT A2, OUT A3, OUT A4, OUT B1, OUT B2, OUT B3 or OUT B4 is displayed in the Y part.

Assign Parameter Source

Setting range PGM, PVW, CLN, ME PGM, AUX1, AUX2, AUX3, AUX4, MV1, MV2, Key Out

Default value MV1(HDMI OUT1), MV2(HDMI OUT2), AUX4(OUTA1), AUX1(OUTA2), AUX2(OUTA3), AUX3(OUTB1), AUX4(OUTB2), AUX1(OUTB3)

HDMI Output Parameter Size Color Scale Move Detect

Setting range Auto, XGA, WXGA, SXGA, WSXGA+, UXGA, WUXGA, WQHD, Native

Auto, RGB, YUV444, YUV422

Fit-V, Fit-H, Full, Full90%, Full80%

1 to 5

Default value Auto Auto Full 3

Setting menu table

175

Menu Sub menu Parameter 1 Parameter 2 Parameter 3 Parameter 4

Use [F1] to select. Use [F2] to select. Use [F3] to select. Use [F4] to select. Use [F5] to select. Config Operate Parameter Bus Mode Time Unit Delegation

Setting range A/B, PGM-A/ PST-B, PGM-B/ PST-A

Sec, Frame On, Off

Default value PGM-A/PST-B Sec On

Key/DSK Link Parameter Key1 Key2 Key3

Setting range Off, Group1, Group2, Group3

Off, Group1, Group2, Group3

Off, Group1, Group2, Group3

Default value Off Off Off

Key/DSK Link Parameter DSK1 DSK2

Setting range Off, Group1, Group2, Group3

Off, Group1, Group2, Group3

Default value Off Off

Assign Parameter FTB Source DSK1 on AUX1 DSK2 on AUX2

Setting range Still1, Still2, Clip1, Clip2, CBGD1, CBGD2, White, Black

On, Off On, Off

Default value Black Off Off

Latency Parameter BKGD Key

Setting range 1F Fix, Minimum

1F Fix, Minimum

Default value Minimum Minimum

LCD Backlight Parameter Light Adjust

Setting range On, Off, 60, 120, 180

80%, 90%, 100%, 110%, 120%, 130%, 140%, 150%

Default value On 100%

Button Illumination

Parameter Dimmer Lighting XPT Color Transition Color

Setting range Off, 80%, 90%, 100%, 110%, 120%, 130%, 140%, 150%

Input, Color Group1, Color Group2, Color Group3, Color Group4, Color Group5, Color Group6, Color Group7, Color Group8

Default value 100% 150% Input Input

Color Group SDI IN 1/2

Parameter IN1 IN2 SDI IN3 SDI IN4

Setting range Color Group1, Color Group2, Color Group3, Color Group4, Color Group5, Color Group6, Color Group7, Color Group8

Default value Color Group1 Color Group1 Color Group1 Color Group1

Color Group SDI IN 2/2

Parameter SDI IN5 SDI IN6 SDI IN7 SDI IN8

Setting range The setting range is the same as for the Color Group SDI IN 1/2 sub menu. Default value Color Group1 Color Group1 Color Group1 Color Group1

Color Group HDMI IN

Parameter HDMI IN1 HDMI IN2

Setting range The setting range is the same as for the Color Group SDI IN 1/2 sub menu. Default value Color Group1 Color Group1 Color Group1 Color Group1

Color Group Option

Parameter IN-A1 IN-A2 IN-A3 IN-A4

Setting range The setting range is the same as for the Color Group SDI IN 1/2 sub menu. Default value Color Group1 Color Group1 Color Group1 Color Group1

Setting menu table

176

Menu Sub menu Parameter 1 Parameter 2 Parameter 3 Parameter 4

Use [F1] to select. Use [F2] to select. Use [F3] to select. Use [F4] to select. Use [F5] to select. Config Color Group

Option Parameter IN-B1 IN-B2 IN-B3 IN-B4

Setting range The setting range is the same as for the Color Group SDI IN 1/2 sub menu. Default value Color Group1 Color Group1 Color Group1 Color Group1

Color Group Internal

Parameter Black CBGD 1 CBGD 2 CBAR

Setting range The setting range is the same as for the Color Group SDI IN 1/2 sub menu. Default value Color Group1 Color Group1 Color Group1 Color Group1

Color Group Still

Parameter Still 1V Still 1K Still 2V Still 2K

Setting range The setting range is the same as for the Color Group SDI IN 1/2 sub menu. Default value Color Group1 Color Group1 Color Group1 Color Group1

Color Group Clip

Parameter Clip 1V Clip 1K Clip 2V Clip 2K

Setting range The setting range is the same as for the Color Group SDI IN 1/2 sub menu. Default value Color Group1 Color Group1 Color Group1 Color Group1

Color Group Other

Parameter CLN ME PGM Key Out Shift

Setting range The setting range is the same as for the Color Group SDI IN 1/2 sub menu. Default value Color Group1 Color Group1 Color Group1 Color Group1

Color Group Transition

Parameter AUTO CUT MIX WIPE

Setting range The setting range is the same as for the Color Group SDI IN 1/2 sub menu. Default value Color Group1 Color Group1 Color Group1 Color Group1

Color Group Next Trans

Parameter BKGD KEY

Setting range The setting range is the same as for the Color Group SDI IN 1/2 sub menu.

Default value Color Group1 Color Group1

Color Group KEY ON

Parameter KEY1 ON KEY2 ON KEY3 ON

Setting range The setting range is the same as for the Color Group SDI IN 1/2 sub menu.

Default value Color Group1 Color Group1 Color Group1

Color Group DSK/FTB ON

Parameter DSK1 ON DSK2 ON FTB ON

Setting range The setting range is the same as for the Color Group SDI IN 1/2 sub menu.

Default value Color Group1 Color Group1 Color Group1

Button Color Group1

Parameter R G B

Setting range 0.0 to 1.5 0.0 to 1.5 0.0 to 1.5

Default value 0.1 0.1 0.1

Setting menu table

177

Menu Sub menu Parameter 1 Parameter 2 Parameter 3 Parameter 4

Use [F1] to select. Use [F2] to select. Use [F3] to select. Use [F4] to select. Use [F5] to select. Config Button Color

Group2 Parameter R G B

Setting range 0.0 to 1.5 0.0 to 1.5 0.0 to 1.5

Default value 0.1 0.1 0.0

Button Color Group3

Parameter R G B

Setting range 0.0 to 1.5 0.0 to 1.5 0.0 to 1.5

Default value 0.0 0.1 0.1

Button Color Group4

Parameter R G B

Setting range 0.0 to 1.5 0.0 to 1.5 0.0 to 1.5

Default value 0.0 0.1 0.1

Button Color Group5

Parameter R G B

Setting range 0.0 to 1.5 0.0 to 1.5 0.0 to 1.5

Default value 0.1 0.0 0.1

Button Color Group6

Parameter R G B

Setting range 0.0 to 1.5 0.0 to 1.5 0.0 to 1.5

Default value 0.1 0.0 0.0

Button Color Group7

Parameter R G B

Setting range 0.0 to 1.5 0.0 to 1.5 0.0 to 1.5

Default value 0.0 0.0 0.1

Button Color Group8

Parameter R G B

Setting range 0.0 to 1.5 0.0 to 1.5 0.0 to 1.5

Default value 0.0 0.0 0.0

WFM Parameter Style Mode

Setting range Parade, Overlay YPbPr, RGB, Y

Default value Parade YPbPr

Vector Parameter Bar Target

Setting range 75%, 100%

Default value 100%

User Button1-4 Parameter User1 User2 User3 User4

Setting range Key1 PVW, Key2 PVW, Key3 PVW, DSK1 PVW, DSK2 PVW, GPII- EN, GPIO-EN, SHIFT, AUX Trans, AUX1 Trans, AUX2 Trans, DSK1 on AUX1, DSK2 on AUX2, Effect Dissolve, None

Default value Key1 PVW Key2 PVW Key3 PVW DSK1 PVW

User Button5-8 Parameter User5 User6 User7 User8

Setting range The setting range is the same as for the User Button1-4 sub menu. Default value DSK2 PVW AUX Trans Effect Dissolve SHIFT

GPI-In Setting Parameter GPI-In Enable AUX Sel

Setting range On, Off AUX1, AUX2, AUX3, AUX4

Default value On AUX1

GPI-In Port1/2 Parameter Port1 Assign Port2 Assign Port3 Assign Port4 Assign

Setting range No Assign, AUTO, CUT, KEY1 ON, KEY2 ON, KEY3 ON, DSK1 ON, DSK2 ON, FTB ON, BKGD AUTO, BKGD CUT, KEY1 AUTO, KEY2 AUTO, KEY3 AUTO, KEY1 CUT, KEY2 CUT, KEY3 CUT, REC Still1, REC Still2, REC Clip1, PLAY Clip1, STOP Clip1, REC Clip2, PLAY Clip2, STOP Clip2, AUX1 to 24, Red Tly DSBL, GRN Tly DSBL, AUX Tly DSBL

Default value No Assign No Assign No Assign No Assign

Setting menu table

178

Menu Sub menu Parameter 1 Parameter 2 Parameter 3 Parameter 4

Use [F1] to select. Use [F2] to select. Use [F3] to select. Use [F4] to select. Use [F5] to select. Config GPI-In Port2/2 Parameter Port5 Assign Port6 Assign Port7 Assign Port8 Assign

Setting range The setting range is the same as for the GPI-In Port1/2 sub menu. Default value No Assign No Assign No Assign No Assign

GPI-Out Setting

Parameter GPI-Out Enable AUX Tly Sel

Setting range On, Off AUX1, AUX2, AUX3, AUX4

Default value On AUX1

GPI-Out Port1/5

Parameter Port1 Assign Port2 Assign Port3 Assign Port4 Assign

Setting range No Assign, AUTO, CUT, KEY1 ON, KEY2 ON, KEY3 ON, DSK1 ON, DSK2 ON, FTB ON, BKGD AUTO, BKGD CUT, KEY1 AUTO, KEY2 AUTO, KEY3 AUTO, KEY1 CUT, KEY2 CUT, KEY3 CUT, Red Tly 1 to 13, GRN Tly 1 to 13, AUX Tly 1 to 13, Event MEM

Default value No Assign No Assign No Assign No Assign

GPI-Out Port2/5

Parameter Port5 Assign Port6 Assign Port7 Assign Port8 Assign

Setting range The setting range is the same as for the GPI-Out Port1/5 sub menu. Default value No Assign No Assign No Assign No Assign

GPI-Out Port3/5

Parameter Port9 Assign Port10 Assign Port11 Assign Port12 Assign

Setting range The setting range is the same as for the GPI-Out Port1/5 sub menu. Default value No Assign No Assign No Assign No Assign

GPI-Out Port4/5

Parameter Port13 Assign Port14 Assign Port15 Assign Port16 Assign

Setting range The setting range is the same as for the GPI-Out Port1/5 sub menu. Default value No Assign No Assign No Assign No Assign

GPI-Out Port5/5

Parameter Port17 Assign Port18 Assign Port19 Assign

Setting range The setting range is the same as for the GPI-Out Port1/5 sub menu.

Default value No Assign No Assign No Assign

System Menu Parameter Lock

Setting range On, Off

Default value Off

Key Source Signal Coupling1

Parameter Fill/Source

Setting range Fill To Source, Source To Fill

Default value Fill To Source

Key Source Signal Coupling2

Parameter IN1 IN2 SDI IN3 SDI IN4

Setting range IN1, IN2, SDI IN3, SDI IN4, SDI IN5, SDI IN6, SDI IN7, SDI IN8, IN- A1, IN-A2, IN-A3, IN-A4, IN-B1, IN-B2, IN-B3, IN-B4, Black, CBGD 1, CBGD 2, CBAR, Still 1V, Still 1K, Still 2V, Still 2K, Clip 1V, Clip 1K, Clip 2V, Clip 2K

Default value IN1 IN2 SDI IN3 SDI IN4

Key Source Signal Coupling3

Parameter SDI IN5 SDI IN6 SDI IN7 SDI IN8

Setting range The setting range is the same as for the Key Source Signal Coupling2 sub menu.

Default value SDI IN5 SDI IN6 SDI IN7 SDI IN8

Setting menu table

179

Menu Sub menu Parameter 1 Parameter 2 Parameter 3 Parameter 4

Use [F1] to select. Use [F2] to select. Use [F3] to select. Use [F4] to select. Use [F5] to select. Config Key Source

Signal Coupling4

Parameter IN-A1 IN-A2 IN-A3 IN-A4

Setting range The setting range is the same as for the Key Source Signal Coupling2 sub menu.

Default value IN-A1 IN-A2 IN-A3 IN-A4

Key Source Signal Coupling5

Parameter IN-B1 IN-B2 IN-B3 IN-B4

Setting range The setting range is the same as for the Key Source Signal Coupling2 sub menu.

Default value IN-B1 IN-B2 IN-B3 IN-B4

Key Source Signal Coupling6

Parameter Black CBGD 1 CBGD 2 CBAR

Setting range The setting range is the same as for the Key Source Signal Coupling2 sub menu.

Default value Black CBGD 1 CBGD 2 CBAR

Key Source Signal Coupling7

Parameter Still 1V Still 1K Still 2V Still 2K

Setting range The setting range is the same as for the Key Source Signal Coupling2 sub menu.

Default value Still 1V Still 1K Still 2V Still 2K

Key Source Signal Coupling8

Parameter Clip 1V Clip 1K Clip 2V Clip 2K

Setting range The setting range is the same as for the Key Source Signal Coupling2 sub menu.

Default value Clip 1V Clip 1K Clip 2V Clip 2K

System/Locked

(When locked)

(All menus grayed out)

System

(When unlocked)

Format Parameter Format Switcher Mode Color Space

Setting range 2160/59.94P, 50P, 29.97P, 25P, 24P, 23.98P 1080/59.94P, 50P, 29.97Psf, 25Psf, 24Psf, 23.98Psf, 59.94i, 50i 720/59.94P, 50P

2K, 4K HDR, BT.2020, HDR BT.709, SDR BT.709

Default value 1080/59.94i 2K SDR BT.709

Output Phase Parameter System H-Phase V-Phase

Setting range 0H, 1H 0.50 to 0.49 100 to 100

Default value 0H 0 0

Reference Parameter Sync BB Setup Gen Lock

Setting range BB, BB Advanced, Tri- level Sync, Internal

0IRE, 7.5IRE Locked, Unlock

Default value BB 7.5IRE Unlock

Ancillary Parameter AUX PGM PVW MV

Setting range On, Off On, Off On, Off PGM, PVW, Off

Default value Off Off Off Off

Alarm Parameter Power Fan Temperature

Setting range Alarm, No Alarm

Alarm, No Alarm

Alarm, No Alarm

Default value

Setting menu table

180

Menu Sub menu Parameter 1 Parameter 2 Parameter 3 Parameter 4

Use [F1] to select. Use [F2] to select. Use [F3] to select. Use [F4] to select. Use [F5] to select. System

(When unlocked)

Initial Parameter Initial Fader Initial

Setting range Execute Execute

Default value

Network1 Parameter IP Address

Setting range 0 to 255

Default value 192.168.0.8

Network2 Parameter Subnet Mask

Setting range 0 to 255

Default value 192.168.0.8

Network3 Parameter Default Gateway

Setting range 0 to 255

Default value 192.168.0.8

Network4 Parameter MAC Address

Setting range Display only

Default value

EXT_PANEL_IP Parameter PortNo SMEM Recall CBGD

SMEM Recall XPT

Setting range 62000 to 65535 On, Off On, Off

Default value 62010 Off Off

Tally Mode Parameter Tally Target

Setting range On, Off

Default value On

Tally MV Color Parameter Group1 Group2 Group3 Group4

Setting range Red Red, Green, Yellow, Orange

Default value Red Green Yellow Orange

Tally Target Parameter Group1 Group2 Group3 Group4

Setting range Off, PGM, CLN, ME PGM, Key Out, AUX1, AUX2, AUX3, AUX4

Off, PGM, PVW, CLN, ME PGM, Key Out, AUX1, AUX2, AUX3, AUX4

Default value PGM PVW CLN AUX1

Now Parameter Get Date Get Time

Setting range Execute Execute

Default value

Date Parameter Year Month Day Set

Setting range 2000 to 2037 1 to 12 1 to 31 Execute

Default value

Time Parameter Hour Minute Second Set

Setting range 0 to 23 0 to 59 0 to 59 Execute

Default value

System Version Parameter System Version Set Delete

Setting range Version number Execute Execute

Default value

Option Parameter Slot A Slot B

Setting range SDI-IN, HDMI-IN, SDI-OUT, HDMI- OUT, 4K-DVE, None

Default value

Setting menu table

181

Appendix (glossary)

Defined below are the terms used in this manual.

Word Explanation

AB Bus system A bus control mode. By executing a transition, the A bus and B bus signals are output to the program images alternately.

Ancillary Data The auxiliary data other than the video signals which is transmitted inside the data stream of the video serial interface. The data superimposed on the vertical blanking period is referred to as the V ancillary data (VANC).

Aspect ratio The ratio between the horizontal and vertical dimensions of an image or screen. It is 16:9 for the HD format and 4:3 for the SD format.

AUX [Auxiliary Bus]

A spare bus which can be switched by signals other than the main line output signals.

BB [Black burst]

The black burst signal. A full-screen black level composite signal which is used as the reference signal for gen-lock.

Border The area or margin that is added to the edge of a wipe or key. Its width and color can be adjusted. The defocusing of the area around a border is referred to as the soft effect.

Chroma key This refers to the function for creating the key signals based on the color information of the video signals and combining the keys.

Clip The threshold level of the luminance when key signals are created from a key source.

Color Background The signals which are output from the internal color generator and used as the background image.

Cut This refers to the effect where the display is instantly switched to the next image.

Density A parameter which is used to adjust the density of the key signals.

Down Converter This is the function that converts material in the 4K format into the 2K/HD format.

DSK [Downstream Key] This refers to the key combination process which is performed at the end of the mix effect. The key is always combined with the foremost image.

DVE [Digital Video Effect] This refers to the transition patterns accompanying size reductions or slide effects.

Embedded Audio This refers to the audio data packets which are transferred inside the data stream of the video serial interface.

Flip Flop system (PGM/PST system)

A bus control mode. The signals selected by the program bus are always output as the program images. By executing a transition, the program bus and preset bus signals are switched over.

Flying Key This function uses DVE effects to move, expand or reduce key signals.

Frame Synchronizer A function which matches the synchronization of non-synchronized video input signals.

Freeze A function which continues the display of the same image, creating the impression that the image has been frozen.

FTB [Fade to Black] This is the effect where the background image is faded out to the black screen.

Genlock A function for synchronizing the video signals using an external sync signal as the reference.

GPI [General Purpose Interface]

Interface signals which control auto transition from an external source.

Hue The color tone of the video signals.

IRE A unit used for video signal levels. The setup level (black level) of the signals is expressed as 0 IRE, 7.5 IRE, etc.

Key Edge The border or shadow added to the edges of keys.

182

Word Explanation

Key Fill The signal that uses key combination processing to fill in the areas left blank by the key signals.

Key Gain A parameter which is used to adjust the amplitude of the key signals.

Key Invert A function which inverts the key signals.

Key Mask This is the function that specifies the area for key combination using the box pattern, etc. When only part of the area of the key signals is used, key combination is executed with the unnecessary area masked.

Key Source The video signals for creating the key signals.

Line Synchronizer A function to automatically adjust the input image signal phase to the horizontal synchronization reference signal phase.

Linear Key The function which combines keys using monochrome key signals with gradations in its outlines as a reference.

Lum [Luminance]

The brightness portion of the video signals.

Luminance Key The function which creates key signals based on the luminance (brightness) information of the video signals to combine keys.

ME [Mix Effect]

A video effect device which combines a number of video signals to create mix, wipe, key and other video signals.

Mix The picture-changing effect produced by overlapping one image with the next. It is also referred to as dissolve.

Multi View Display This function combines multiple materials and displays them on one screen. PGM, PVW and the input material can be previewed at the same time on a single screen.

PinP [Picture in Picture] This function combines a sub screen image with the background image.

PVW [Preview]

The function for checking ahead of time the image which will be output after the next transition. The image is output from the PVW system.

PGM [Program Bus]

The bus which always carries the program output signals.

PST [Preset Bus]

The bus which carries the program output signals after the next background transition.

RS-422 A serial interface standard. It is the interface used to control the switcher from an editor or other external device.

Sat [Saturation]

This refers to the intensity of the color chrominance level of video signals.

SDI [Serial Digital Interface]

The standard by which video signals in various SD and HD formats are transmitted along a single coaxial cable.

Self Key A function that creates key signals from key fill signals for combining keys.

Setup Data The memory in which the control panel statuses can be saved and recalled. The button selection statuses as well as the border, color and other setting information can be saved in this memory.

Tally The signal which outputs the program output statuses of the input signals to an external device. The LED that indicates the program output status on the control panel is also referred to as tally.

Transition A function that switches from one image to another. Wipe, mix and other effects are available for the images during switching.

Tri-level Sync The sync signal used for HD formats.

Appendix (glossary)

183

Word Explanation

Trimming This is the function that eliminates the unnecessary parts at the top, bottom, left and/or right of the images which are combined using the PinP function.

Up Converter This is the function that converts material in the 2K/HD format into the 4K format which yields a high resolution.

Video Memory This is the memory in which the images (still images and moving images) with key signals can be stored.

Wipe A video effect in which one image is gradually replaced by another as the boundary between the two is moved using a preselected pattern.

Appendix (glossary)

184

A AUX bus crosspoint button ................................... 18

B Background ........................................................... 152

3D Modify ........................................................... 152 Border ................................................................. 152 Border Color ....................................................... 152 Modify ................................................................. 152 Position ............................................................... 152

BKGD, KEY pattern selector button ...................... 19

C Camera .................................................................. 162

ABB .................................................................... 163 AWB ................................................................... 162 Camera Control .................................................. 162 Camera Information ............................................ 162 Control Speed .................................................... 162 Gain1 .................................................................. 163 Gain2 .................................................................. 163 Lens Control ....................................................... 162 Lock .................................................................... 163 OSD Menu & Color Bars .................................... 162 Pedestal .............................................................. 163 Preset Settings ................................................... 163

Chroma Key ........................................................... 158 Adjust ................................................................. 158 Auto Compute ..................................................... 158 Chroma Key ........................................................ 158 Fine Tuning ......................................................... 158 Sampling ............................................................ 158 Sampling Area .................................................... 158

Color Background ................................................ 153 CBGD1 Main ...................................................... 153 CBGD1 Move ..................................................... 153 CBGD1 Sub ........................................................ 153 CBGD1 Wash ..................................................... 153 CBGD1 Wave ..................................................... 153 CBGD2 Main ...................................................... 153 CBGD2 Move ..................................................... 153 CBGD2 Sub ........................................................ 153 CBGD2 Wash ..................................................... 153 CBGD2 Wave ..................................................... 153

Config .................................................................... 175 Assign ................................................................. 175 Button Color Group1 .......................................... 176 Button Color Group2 .......................................... 177 Button Color Group3 .......................................... 177 Button Color Group4 .......................................... 177 Button Color Group5 .......................................... 177 Button Color Group6 .......................................... 177 Button Color Group7 .......................................... 177 Button Color Group8 .......................................... 177

Button Illumination .............................................. 175 Color Group Clip ................................................. 176 Color Group DSK/FTB ON ................................. 176 Color Group HDMI IN ......................................... 175 Color Group Internal ........................................... 176 Color Group KEY ON ......................................... 176 Color Group Next Trans ...................................... 176 Color Group Option ............................................ 175 Color Group Other .............................................. 176 Color Group SDI IN 1/2 ...................................... 175 Color Group SDI IN 2/2 ...................................... 175 Color Group Still ................................................. 176 Color Group Transition ........................................ 176 GPI-In Port1/2 ..................................................... 177 GPI-In Port2/2 ..................................................... 178 GPI-In Setting ..................................................... 177 GPI-Out Port1/5 .................................................. 178 GPI-Out Port2/5 .................................................. 178 GPI-Out Port3/5 .................................................. 178 GPI-Out Port4/5 .................................................. 178 GPI-Out Port5/5 .................................................. 178 GPI-Out Setting .................................................. 178 Key/DSK Link ..................................................... 175 Key Source Signal Coupling1 ............................. 178 Key Source Signal Coupling2 ............................. 178 Key Source Signal Coupling3 ............................. 178 Key Source Signal Coupling4 ............................. 179 Key Source Signal Coupling5 ............................. 179 Key Source Signal Coupling6 ............................. 179 Key Source Signal Coupling7 ............................. 179 Key Source Signal Coupling8 ............................. 179 Latency ............................................................... 175 LCD Backlight ..................................................... 175 Operate .............................................................. 175 System Menu ...................................................... 178 User Button1-4 ................................................... 177 User Button5-8 ................................................... 177 Vector ................................................................. 177 WFM ................................................................... 177

D DSK1 ...................................................................... 158

Adjust ................................................................. 158 DSK1 .................................................................. 158 DSK On .............................................................. 159 DSK Priority ........................................................ 159 DSK Signal Coupling .......................................... 159 Fill Matte ............................................................. 158 Mask ................................................................... 159 Mask Adjust ........................................................ 159 PinP .................................................................... 159 PinP Border ........................................................ 159 PinP Position ...................................................... 159 PinP Sync ........................................................... 159 PinP Trim ............................................................ 159 PinP Trim Adjust ................................................. 159

DSK2 ...................................................................... 160 Adjust ................................................................. 160 DSK1 .................................................................. 160

Index

185

DSK On .............................................................. 160 DSK Priority ........................................................ 160 DSK Signal Coupling .......................................... 160 Fill Matte ............................................................. 160 Mask ................................................................... 160 Mask Adjust ........................................................ 160

E Event Memory ....................................................... 167

Event Duration .................................................... 167 Mark ................................................................... 167 Path .................................................................... 167 Play ..................................................................... 167 Register .............................................................. 167 Target Select1 .................................................... 167 Target Select2 .................................................... 167 Timeline .............................................................. 167 Total Duration ..................................................... 167

F Fader lever .............................................................. 21

I Input ............................................................... 170, 173

Camera Settings1 ............................................... 173 Camera Settings2 ............................................... 173 Camera Settings3 ............................................... 173 Camera Settings4 ............................................... 173 Input ................................................................... 170

Input (HDMI) .......................................................... 172 C/C Matrix B ....................................................... 172 C/C Matrix R/G ................................................... 172 C/C Operation ..................................................... 172 C/C Process ....................................................... 172 C/C Setting ......................................................... 172 C/C Tone1 Black ................................................. 172 C/C Tone2 Gray L ............................................... 172 C/C Tone3 Gray H .............................................. 172 C/C Tone4 White ................................................. 172 Freeze ................................................................ 172 HDMI Input ......................................................... 172 HDMI Status ....................................................... 172 Limited ................................................................ 172 Name .................................................................. 172

Input (SDI) ............................................................. 171 C/C Matrix B ....................................................... 171 C/C Matrix R/G ................................................... 171 C/C Operation ..................................................... 171 C/C Process ....................................................... 171 C/C Setting ......................................................... 171 C/C Tone1 Black ................................................. 171 C/C Tone2 Gray L ............................................... 171 C/C Tone3 Gray H .............................................. 171 C/C Tone4 White ................................................. 171 Freeze ................................................................ 171 FS ....................................................................... 171

Name .................................................................. 171 Status ................................................................. 171 Up/Down Converter ............................................ 171

K Key1 ....................................................................... 154

3D Modify ........................................................... 154 Adjust ................................................................. 154 Edge1 ................................................................. 154 Edge2 ................................................................. 154 Edge Color ......................................................... 154 Fill Matte ............................................................. 154 Flying Key ........................................................... 154 Key1 ................................................................... 154 Key On ................................................................ 155 Key Priority ......................................................... 155 Key Signal Coupling ........................................... 155 Mask ................................................................... 155 Mask Adjust ........................................................ 155 PinP .................................................................... 155 PinP Border ........................................................ 155 PinP Position ...................................................... 155 PinP Sync ........................................................... 155 PinP Trim ............................................................ 155 PinP Trim Adjust ................................................. 155 Position ............................................................... 154 Transition ............................................................ 154

Key2 ....................................................................... 156 Adjust ................................................................. 156 Edge1 ................................................................. 156 Edge2 ................................................................. 156 Edge Color ......................................................... 156 Fill Matte ............................................................. 156 Key1 ................................................................... 156 Key On ................................................................ 157 Key Priority ......................................................... 157 Key Signal Coupling ........................................... 157 Mask ................................................................... 156 Mask Adjust ........................................................ 156 PinP .................................................................... 156 PinP Border ........................................................ 156 PinP Position ...................................................... 156 PinP Sync ........................................................... 157 PinP Trim ............................................................ 157 PinP Trim Adjust ................................................. 157

Key3 ....................................................................... 157 Adjust ................................................................. 157 Fill Matte ............................................................. 157 Key1 ................................................................... 157 Key On ................................................................ 157 Key Priority ......................................................... 157 Key Signal Coupling ........................................... 157 Mask ................................................................... 157 Mask Adjust ........................................................ 157

L LAN cable .............................................................. 127

Index

186

M Macro ..................................................................... 166

Insert Delay ........................................................ 166 Macro Assign 1/6 ................................................ 166 Macro Assign 2/6 ................................................ 166 Macro Assign 3/6 ................................................ 166 Macro Assign 4/6 ................................................ 166 Macro Assign 5/6 ................................................ 166 Macro Assign 6/6 ................................................ 166 Store Select1 ...................................................... 166 Store Select2 ...................................................... 166

Memory operation button ...................................... 19

Menu ........................................................................ 28

Menu selection buttons ................................... 23, 28

Multi View Display ................................................. 168 Display ........................................................ 169, 170 MV1 Frame ......................................................... 169 MV1 Pattern 1/4 .................................................. 169 MV1 Pattern 2/4 .................................................. 169 MV1 Pattern 3/4 .................................................. 169 MV1 Pattern 4/4 .................................................. 169 MV1 Split ............................................................ 169 MV1 Tally Group1 ............................................... 169 MV1 Tally Group2 ............................................... 169 MV2 Frame ......................................................... 170 MV2 Pattern 1/4 .................................................. 170 MV2 Pattern 2/4 .................................................. 170 MV2 Pattern 3/4 .................................................. 170 MV2 Pattern 4/4 .................................................. 170 MV2 Split ............................................................ 170 MV2 Tally Green ................................................. 170 MV2 Tally Red .................................................... 170

O Output .................................................................... 173

Output ................................................................. 173

Output (HDMI) ....................................................... 174 Assign ................................................................. 174 HDMI Output ...................................................... 174

Output (SDI) .......................................................... 173 Assign ................................................................. 173 Down Converter .................................................. 173

P PGM/A bus crosspoint button ............................... 18

Positioner ................................................................ 24

Project File ............................................................ 163 Last Load Date ................................................... 163 Last Load File ..................................................... 163 Project File ......................................................... 163

Target Select1 .................................................... 163 Target Select2 .................................................... 163

PST/B bus crosspoint button ................................ 18

R Rotary encoder ............................................ 23, 24, 28

S SD Card ................................................................. 164

Card Information ................................................. 164 Card Management .............................................. 164 Create Thumbnail ............................................... 164 File ...................................................................... 164 Mode .................................................................. 164 Target Select1 .................................................... 164 Target Select2 .................................................... 164

Shot Memory ......................................................... 167 Path .................................................................... 167 Register .............................................................. 167 Target Select1 .................................................... 167 Target Select2 .................................................... 167

System ................................................................... 179 Alarm .................................................................. 179 Ancillary .............................................................. 179 Date .................................................................... 180 EXT_PANEL_IP .................................................. 180 Format ................................................................ 179 Initial ................................................................... 180 Network1 ............................................................ 180 Network2 ............................................................ 180 Network3 ............................................................ 180 Network4 ............................................................ 180 Now .................................................................... 180 Option ................................................................. 180 Output Phase ..................................................... 179 Reference ........................................................... 179 System Version ................................................... 180 Tally Mode .......................................................... 180 Tally MV Color .................................................... 180 Tally Target .......................................................... 180 Time ................................................................... 180

T Time ....................................................................... 161

AUX1 BUS Trans ................................................ 161 AUX2 BUS Trans ................................................ 161 BKGD ................................................................. 161 DSK1 .................................................................. 161 DSK2 .................................................................. 161 Effect Dissolve .................................................... 161 FTB ..................................................................... 161 Key1 ................................................................... 161 Key2 ................................................................... 161 Key3 ................................................................... 161

Index

187

U User button ............................................................. 20

V Video Memory ....................................................... 165

Limit Time ........................................................... 165 Memory .............................................................. 165 Play Mode1 ......................................................... 165 Play Mode2 ......................................................... 165 Rec1 ................................................................... 165 Rec2 ................................................................... 165 Rec3 ................................................................... 165 Video Memory1 .................................................. 165 Video Memory2 .................................................. 165 Video Memory3 .................................................. 165

X XPT ......................................................................... 168

XPT Assign 1/6 ................................................... 168 XPT Assign 2/6 ................................................... 168 XPT Assign 3/6 ................................................... 168 XPT Assign 4/6 ................................................... 168 XPT Assign 5/6 ................................................... 168 XPT Assign 6/6 ................................................... 168 XPT Setting ........................................................ 168 XPT Switch ......................................................... 168

Index

Manualsnet FAQs

If you want to find out how the AV-UHS500P Panasonic works, you can view and download the Panasonic AV-UHS500P Operating Instructions on the Manualsnet website.

Yes, we have the Operating Instructions for Panasonic AV-UHS500P as well as other Panasonic manuals. All you need to do is to use our search bar and find the user manual that you are looking for.

The Operating Instructions should include all the details that are needed to use a Panasonic AV-UHS500P. Full manuals and user guide PDFs can be downloaded from Manualsnet.com.

The best way to navigate the Panasonic AV-UHS500P Operating Instructions is by checking the Table of Contents at the top of the page where available. This allows you to navigate a manual by jumping to the section you are looking for.

This Panasonic AV-UHS500P Operating Instructions consists of sections like Table of Contents, to name a few. For easier navigation, use the Table of Contents in the upper left corner.

You can download Panasonic AV-UHS500P Operating Instructions free of charge simply by clicking the “download” button in the upper right corner of any manuals page. This feature allows you to download any manual in a couple of seconds and is generally in PDF format. You can also save a manual for later by adding it to your saved documents in the user profile.

To be able to print Panasonic AV-UHS500P Operating Instructions, simply download the document to your computer. Once downloaded, open the PDF file and print the Panasonic AV-UHS500P Operating Instructions as you would any other document. This can usually be achieved by clicking on “File” and then “Print” from the menu bar.